cab30c6af8ccb9f8e7b8ab408399794954923fbd
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2022 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{am335xgpio}
588 @* A Texas Instruments AM335x-based board (e.g. BeagleBone Black) using the GPIO pins of the expansion headers.
589
590 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
591 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
592 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
593
594 @item @b{vdebug}
595 @* A driver for Cadence virtual Debug Interface to emulated or simulated targets.
596 It implements a client connecting to the vdebug server, which in turn communicates
597 with the emulated or simulated RTL model through a transactor. The driver supports
598 JTAG and DAP-level transports.
599
600 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
601 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
602 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
603 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
604 emulation model of target hardware.
605
606 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
607 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
608
609 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
610 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
611
612 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
613 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
614 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
615
616 @item @b{esp_usb_jtag}
617 @* A JTAG driver to communicate with builtin debug modules of Espressif ESP32-C3 and ESP32-S3 chips using OpenOCD.
618
619 @end itemize
620
621 @node About Jim-Tcl
622 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
623 @cindex Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex tcl
625
626 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
627 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
628 command interpreter.
629
630 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
631 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
632 much of anything about Tcl.
633 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
634
635 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
636 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
637 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
638 OpenOCD mailing list.
639
640 @itemize @bullet
641 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
642 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
643 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
644 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
645 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
646 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
647
648 @item @b{Missing Features}
649 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
650 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
651 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
652 enabled in OpenOCD.
653
654 @item @b{Scripts}
655 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
656 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
657 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
658
659 @item @b{Commands}
660 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
661 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
662 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
663 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
664
665 @item @b{Historical Note}
666 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
667 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
668 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
669 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
670
671 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
672 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
673 @end itemize
674
675 @node Running
676 @chapter Running
677 @cindex command line options
678 @cindex logfile
679 @cindex directory search
680
681 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
682 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
683 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
684 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
685 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
686 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
687 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
688
689 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
690 tell it how each debug session should work.
691 The @option{--help} option shows:
692 @verbatim
693 bash$ openocd --help
694
695 --help | -h display this help
696 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
697 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
698 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
699 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
700 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
701 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
702 --command | -c run <command>
703 @end verbatim
704
705 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
706 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
707 To specify one or more different
708 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
709
710 @example
711 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
712 @end example
713
714 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
715 @enumerate
716 @item the current directory,
717 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
718 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
719 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
720 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
721 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
722 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
723 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
724 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
725 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
726 @end enumerate
727 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
728
729 @quotation Note
730 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
731 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
732 @end quotation
733
734 @section Simple setup, no customization
735
736 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
737 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
738 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
739 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
740 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
741
742 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
743 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
744 the server with some variation of one of the following:
745
746 @example
747 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
748 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
749 @end example
750
751 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
752 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
753 If all goes well you'll see output something like
754
755 @example
756 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
757 For bug reports, read
758 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
759 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
760 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
761 @end example
762
763 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
764 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
765 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
766
767 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
768
769 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
770 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
771 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
772 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
773 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
774 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
775 ensure that this always succeeds.
776 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
777 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
778 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
779 and then shut down without acting as a server.
780
781 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
782 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
783 those channels.
784
785 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
786 the @option{-d} option.
787
788 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
789 @option{-c} command line switch.
790
791 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
792 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
793 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
794 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
795 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
796 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
797 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
798
799 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
800 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
801
802 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
803 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
804 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
805 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
806
807 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
808 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
809
810 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
811 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
812 and start the OpenOCD server.
813 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
814 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
815 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
816 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
817
818 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
819
820 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
821 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
822 and a USB cable on the other.
823 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
824 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
825
826 @enumerate
827 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
828 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
829 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
830 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
831 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
832 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
833 debugging host.
834
835 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
836 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
837 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
838 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
839 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
840
841 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
842 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
843 with 1.2 Volt boards.
844
845 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
846 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
847 ways to connect the cable.
848 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
849 Be sure it's firmly connected.
850
851 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
852 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
853 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
854 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
855 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
856 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
857 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
858 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
859
860 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
861 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
862 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
863 but are tedious to set up.
864 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
865 adapter signals to the right board pins.
866
867 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
868 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
869 you are using to run OpenOCD.
870 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
871
872 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
873 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
874 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
875 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
876
877 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
878 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
879 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
880
881 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
882 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
883 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
884 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
885
886 @end enumerate
887
888 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
889 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
890 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
891
892 @section Project Directory
893
894 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
895
896 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
897 single directory for your work with a given board.
898 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
899 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
900 files accessed through semihosting,
901 and for code you upload to the target board.
902 It is also the natural place to write files,
903 such as log files and data you download from the board.
904
905 @section Configuration Basics
906
907 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
908 a variety of ways you can mix them.
909 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
910
911 @itemize
912 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
913 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
914 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
915 @end itemize
916
917 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
918 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
919 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
920
921 @example
922 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
923
924 # GDB can also flash my flash!
925 gdb_memory_map enable
926 gdb_flash_program enable
927
928 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
929 @end example
930
931 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
932
933 @example
934 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
935 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
936 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
937 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
938 @end example
939
940 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
941 each supporting a different development task.
942 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
943 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
944
945 @quotation Important
946 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
947 problems with how it treats variables.
948 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
949 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
950 that can be tested in a later script.
951 @end quotation
952
953 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
954 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
955 to simplify your work.
956
957 @section User Config Files
958 @cindex config file, user
959 @cindex user config file
960 @cindex config file, overview
961
962 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
963 in one place.
964 One of the following will match your situation best:
965
966 @itemize
967 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
968 provided by someone else.
969 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
970 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
971 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
972 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
973 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
974 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
975
976 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
977 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
978
979 @enumerate
980 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
981 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
982 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
983 @end enumerate
984
985 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
986 The first is an interface config file.
987 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
988 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
989 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
990 meet your deadline:
991
992 @example
993 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
994 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
995 @end example
996
997 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
998 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
999 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1000 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1001
1002 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1003 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1004 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1005 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1006 target and board
1007 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1008 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1009
1010 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1011 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1012 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1013 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1014
1015 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1016 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1017 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1018 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1019 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1020
1021 @quotation Note
1022 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1023 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1024 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1025 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1026 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1027 @end quotation
1028
1029 @item
1030 You may need to write some C code.
1031 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1032 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1033 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1034 a new chip architecture.
1035 @end itemize
1036
1037 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1038 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1039 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1040
1041 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1042 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1043 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1044 @itemize
1045
1046 @item
1047 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1048 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1049 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1050 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1051
1052 @item
1053 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1054 @cindex vector_catch
1055 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1056 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1057 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1058 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1059 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1060 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1061
1062 @item
1063 You might need to override some defaults.
1064 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1065 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1066
1067 @item
1068 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1069 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1070 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1071 @end itemize
1072
1073 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1074
1075 A few project-specific utility
1076 routines may well speed up your work.
1077 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1078
1079 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1080 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1081 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1082 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1083 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1084 may help:
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1089 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1090 # Leave the CPU halted.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1094 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1095
1096 # Start running.
1097 resume 0x20000000
1098 @}
1099 @end example
1100
1101 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1102 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1103 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1104 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1105 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1106
1107 @example
1108 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1109 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1110 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1111 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1112 reset init
1113
1114 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1115 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1116 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1117 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1118 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1119 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1120 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1121
1122 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1123 reset run
1124 @}
1125 @end example
1126
1127 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1128 from NAND.
1129 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1130 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1131 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1132
1133 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1134 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1135
1136 @section Target Software Changes
1137
1138 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1139 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1140 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1141 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1142 handling issues like:
1143
1144 @itemize @bullet
1145
1146 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1147 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1148 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1149 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1150 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1151 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1152 your debug sessions.
1153
1154 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1155 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1156 That might however be your only option.
1157
1158 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1159 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1160 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1161 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1162 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1163 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1164 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1165 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1166 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1167 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1168 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1169 instead of the whole thing.
1170 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1171 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1172
1173 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1174 @cindex ARM semihosting
1175 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1176 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1177 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1178 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1179 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1180 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1181 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1182 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1183 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1184 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1185 NAND or SPI flash.
1186
1187 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1188 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1189 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1190 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1191 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1192
1193 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1194 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1195 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1196 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1197 registers which can be used to change various features including
1198 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1199 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1200 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1201 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1202 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1203
1204 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1205 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1206 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1207 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1208 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1209
1210 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1211 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1212 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1213 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1214 early code execution can be debugged
1215 or firmware can be replaced.
1216
1217 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1218 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1219 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1220 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1221 operations like writing to memory.)
1222
1223 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1224 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1225 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1226 various kinds of message.
1227 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1228
1229 @end itemize
1230
1231 @section Target Hardware Setup
1232
1233 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1234 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1235 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1236 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1237 working with.}
1238
1239 Common issues include:
1240
1241 @itemize @bullet
1242
1243 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1244 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1245 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1246 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1247 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1248 or one from a daughtercard).
1249 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1250 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1251
1252 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1253 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1254 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1255 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1256 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1257 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1258
1259 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1260 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1261 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1262 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1263 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1264
1265
1266 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1267 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1268 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1269 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1270 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1271 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1272 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1273
1274 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1275 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1276 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1277 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1278 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1279
1280 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1281 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1282 used to start booting.
1283
1284 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1285 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1286 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1287 multiple audio codec chips).
1288 This interacts with software
1289 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1290 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1291 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1292 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1293 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1294 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1295 audio or video codecs are used.
1296
1297 @end itemize
1298
1299 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1300 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1301 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1302 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1303 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1304 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1305 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1306 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1307 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1308 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1309
1310
1311 @node Config File Guidelines
1312 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1313
1314 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1315 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1316 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1317 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1318
1319 You should find the following directories under
1320 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1321 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1322 @itemize @bullet
1323 @item @file{interface} ...
1324 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1325 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1326 @item @file{board} ...
1327 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1328 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1329
1330 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1331 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1332 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1333 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1334 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1335 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1336 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1337 a CPU and an FPGA.
1338 @item @file{target} ...
1339 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1340 on a chip
1341 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1342 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1343 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1344 the target config file defines all of them.
1345 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1346 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1347 @end itemize
1348
1349 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1350 file may override features in any of the above files by
1351 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1352 commands specific to their situation.
1353
1354 @section Interface Config Files
1355
1356 The user config file
1357 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1358
1359 @example
1360 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1361 @end example
1362
1363 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1364 in use today with OpenOCD.
1365 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1366 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1367
1368 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1369 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1370 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1371 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1372 and need to provide a driver for it.
1373
1374 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1375 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1376 @end deffn
1377
1378 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1379 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1380 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1381 to use @command{find}, instead.
1382 @end deffn
1383
1384 @section Board Config Files
1385 @cindex config file, board
1386 @cindex board config file
1387
1388 The user config file
1389 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1390
1391 @example
1392 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1393 @end example
1394
1395 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1396 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1397 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1398
1399 @enumerate
1400 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1401 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1402 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1403 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1404 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1405 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1406 @end enumerate
1407
1408 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1409 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1410 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1411 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1412
1413 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1414 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1415 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1416 configuration works.
1417
1418 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1419
1420 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1421 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1422 convention on how to use certain variables.
1423
1424 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1425 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1426 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1427 used at will within a target configuration file.
1428
1429 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1430 for a board with three chips:
1431
1432 @example
1433 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1434 set CHIPNAME network
1435 set ENDIAN big
1436 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1437 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1438 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1439 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1440
1441 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1442 set CHIPNAME video
1443 set ENDIAN little
1444 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1445 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1446 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1447 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1448
1449 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1450 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1451 unset ENDIAN
1452 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1453 @end example
1454
1455 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1456 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1457 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1458 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1459 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1460 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1461 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1462 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1463
1464 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1465 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1466 naming collisions.
1467
1468 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1469 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1470 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1471 up other clocks and peripherals.
1472
1473 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1474 @cindex variable names
1475
1476 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1477 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1478 one such chip (as shown above).
1479 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1480 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1481 to promote consistency and
1482 so that board files can override target defaults.
1483
1484 Inputs to target config files include:
1485
1486 @itemize @bullet
1487 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1488 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1489 tap identifier dotted names.
1490 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1491 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1492 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1493 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1494 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1495 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1496 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1497 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1498 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1499 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 Outputs from target config files include:
1503
1504 @itemize @bullet
1505 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1506 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1507 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1508 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1509 specific to that board and that target.
1510 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1511 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1512 @end itemize
1513
1514 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1515 @cindex event, reset-init
1516 @cindex reset-init handler
1517
1518 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1519 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1520 fully set up yet.
1521 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1522 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1523 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1524 handler is one of the most important.
1525
1526 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1527 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1528 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1529 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1530 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1531
1532 @quotation Note
1533 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1534 are included here.
1535 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1536 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1537 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1538 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1539 @end quotation
1540
1541 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1542 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1543 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1544 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1545 those as parameters.
1546 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1547 and disabling the watchdog.
1548 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1549 the next developer doing such work.
1550 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1551
1552 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1553 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1554 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1555 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1556
1557 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1558
1559 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1560 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1561 a low JTAG clock rate.
1562 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1563 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1564 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1565 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1566 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1567 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1568 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1569
1570 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1571 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1572 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1573 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1574 which might be less than that.
1575
1576 @quotation Warning
1577 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1578 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1579 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1580 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1581 @end quotation
1582
1583 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1584 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1585 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1586 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1587 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1588 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1589
1590 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1591 @subsection The init_board procedure
1592 @cindex init_board procedure
1593
1594 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1595 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1596 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1597 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1598 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1599 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1600 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1601 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1602 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1603 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1604 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1605 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1606
1607 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1608 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1609
1610 @example
1611 ### board_file.cfg ###
1612
1613 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1614 source [find target/target.cfg]
1615
1616 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1617 # enables fast on-board clock source
1618 # configures the chip to use it
1619 @}
1620
1621 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1622 proc init_board @{@} @{
1623 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1624
1625 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1626 adapter speed 100
1627 @}
1628
1629 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1630 enable_fast_clock
1631 adapter speed 10000
1632 @}
1633 @}
1634 @end example
1635
1636 @section Target Config Files
1637 @cindex config file, target
1638 @cindex target config file
1639
1640 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1641 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1642 more target config files like this:
1643
1644 @example
1645 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1646 @end example
1647
1648 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1649 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1650 In summary the target files should contain
1651
1652 @enumerate
1653 @item Set defaults
1654 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1655 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1656 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1657 @item On-Chip flash
1658 @end enumerate
1659
1660 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1661 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1662 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1663
1664 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1665 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1666 can talk to the chip.
1667 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1668 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1669 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1670 and other processing engines.
1671
1672 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1673
1674 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1675 letting board config files express environment-specific
1676 differences in how things should be set up.
1677
1678 @example
1679 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1680 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1681 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1682 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1683 @} else @{
1684 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1685 @}
1686
1687 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1688 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1689 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1690 @} else @{
1691 set _ENDIAN little
1692 @}
1693
1694 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1695 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1696 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1697 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1698 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1699 @} else @{
1700 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1701 @}
1702 @end example
1703 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1704
1705 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1706 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1707 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1708
1709 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1710 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1711 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1712
1713 @example
1714 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1715 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1716 @end example
1717
1718 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1719 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1720 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1721 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1722 for taps.
1723
1724 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1725 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1726 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1727 looks (in part) like this:
1728
1729 @example
1730 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1731 @end example
1732
1733 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1734 to source such a config file twice, with different
1735 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1736 it adds a different TAP each time.
1737
1738 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1739 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1740 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1741 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1742
1743 @example
1744 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1745 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1746 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1747 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1748 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1749 @end example
1750
1751 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1752 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1753
1754 @itemize
1755 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1756 plus a JRC to enable them
1757 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1758 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1759 is not currently used)
1760 @end itemize
1761
1762 @subsection Add CPU targets
1763
1764 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1765 GDB and other commands can use it.
1766 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1767 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1768 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1769 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1773 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1774 @end example
1775
1776 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1777 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1778 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1779 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1780 a work area if you can.
1781 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1782
1783 @example
1784 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1785 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1786 @end example
1787
1788 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1789 @cindex SMP
1790 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1791
1792 @example
1793 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1794 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1795 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1796 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1797 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1798 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1799 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1800 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1801 @end example
1802 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1803 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1806 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1807 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1808 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1809 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1810 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1811 @end itemize
1812
1813 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1814 command have been implemented.
1815 @itemize @bullet
1816 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1817 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1818 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1819 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1820 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1821 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1822 following example.
1823 @end itemize
1824
1825 @example
1826 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1827 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1828 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1829 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1830 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1831 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1832 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1833 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1834 > resume
1835 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1836 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1837 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1838 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1839 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1840 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1841 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1842 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1843 @end example
1844
1845
1846 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1847
1848 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1849 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1850 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1851
1852 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1853 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1854 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1855 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1856 both signals.
1857
1858 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1859 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1860 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1861 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1862 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1863 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1864 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1865 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1866 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1867 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1868 not available.)
1869
1870 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1871 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1872 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1873 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1874 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1875 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1876 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1877 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1878
1879 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1880 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1881 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1882 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1883 slower clock than they will use later.
1884 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1885 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1886 than they will use later.
1887 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1888
1889 @quotation Important
1890 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1891 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1892 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1893 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1894 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1895 @end quotation
1896
1897 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1898 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1899 @cindex init_targets procedure
1900
1901 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1902 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1903 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1904 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1905 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1906 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1907 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1908 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1909 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1910
1911 @example
1912 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1913
1914 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1915 # basic initialization procedure ...
1916 @}
1917
1918 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1919 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1920 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1921 @}
1922
1923 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1924
1925 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1926
1927 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1928 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1929 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1930 @}
1931 @end example
1932
1933 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1934 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1935
1936 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1937
1938 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1939 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1940
1941 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1942 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1943
1944 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1945 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1946 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1947 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1948 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1949 events already assigned.
1950
1951 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1952
1953 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1954 special high speed download features - enable it.
1955
1956 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1957
1958 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1959 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1960 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1961 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1962 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1963 If you are using an external trace port,
1964 configure it in your board config file.
1965 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1966 configure it in your target config file.
1967
1968 @example
1969 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1970 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1971 @end example
1972
1973 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1974
1975 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1976
1977 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1978 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1979 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1980 the TARGET (chip) file.
1981
1982 Examples:
1983 @itemize @bullet
1984 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1985 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1986 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1987 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1988 @end itemize
1989
1990 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1991 @section Translating Configuration Files
1992 @cindex translation
1993 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1994 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1995 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1996 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1997 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1998 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1999
2000 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2001 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2002 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2003 convert other scripts later on.
2004
2005 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2006 replace job:
2007
2008 @example
2009 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2010 #
2011 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2012 #
2013 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2014 #
2015 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2016
2017 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2018 global TARGETNAME
2019
2020 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2021
2022 arm mcr 15 [expr @{($regs >> 12) & 0x7@}] \
2023 [expr @{($regs >> 0) & 0xf@}] [expr @{($regs >> 4) & 0xf@}] \
2024 [expr @{($regs >> 8) & 0x7@}] $value
2025 @}
2026 @end example
2027
2028
2029
2030 @node Server Configuration
2031 @chapter Server Configuration
2032 @cindex initialization
2033 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2034 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2035 supported.
2036
2037 @anchor{configurationstage}
2038 @section Configuration Stage
2039 @cindex configuration stage
2040 @cindex config command
2041
2042 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2043 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2044 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2045 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2046 inside startup scripts.
2047
2048 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2049 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2050 which may be issued interactively.
2051 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2052 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2053
2054 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2055 flash banks,
2056 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2057 and other basic setup.
2058 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2059 may access or activate TAPs.
2060 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2061 longer be issued.
2062
2063 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2064 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2065 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2066 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2067 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2068
2069 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2070 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2071 the command can be executed in either
2072 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2073 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2074 @end deffn
2075
2076 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2077 @section Entering the Run Stage
2078
2079 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2080 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2081 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2082 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2083 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2084 You should see no errors at this point.
2085 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2086 commands you used to configure the server.
2087 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2088 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2089 on the scan chain.
2090
2091 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2092 become available.
2093 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2094 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2095 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2096 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2097 entry to the run stage.
2098
2099 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2100 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2101 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2102 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2103 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2104 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2105 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2106
2107 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2108 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2109 configuration files and/or command line options.
2110
2111 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2112 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2113 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2114 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2115 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2116
2117 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2118 corresponding subsystems:
2119 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2120 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2121 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2122 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2123 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2124 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2125 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2126 @end deffn
2127
2128 At last, @command{init} executes all the commands that are specified in
2129 the TCL list @var{post_init_commands}. The commands are executed in the
2130 same order they occupy in the list. If one of the commands fails, then
2131 the error is propagated and OpenOCD fails too.
2132 @example
2133 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "OpenOCD successfully initialized."@}
2134 lappend post_init_commands @{echo "Have fun with OpenOCD !"@}
2135 @end example
2136 @end deffn
2137
2138 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2139 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2140 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2141 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2142 the run stage.
2143 @end deffn
2144
2145 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2146 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2147 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2148
2149 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2150 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2151 scan chain.
2152 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2153 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2154
2155 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2156 they return.
2157 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2158 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @anchor{tcpipports}
2162 @section TCP/IP Ports
2163 @cindex TCP port
2164 @cindex server
2165 @cindex port
2166 @cindex security
2167 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2168 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2169 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2170
2171 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2172 access using one or more of these ports.
2173 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2174 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2175 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2176
2177 @anchor{gdb_port}
2178 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2179 @cindex GDB server
2180 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2181 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2182 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2183 the normal use cases.
2184
2185 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2186 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2187 disables the gdb server.
2188
2189 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2190 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2191
2192 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2193 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2194 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2195
2196 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2197 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2198 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2199 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2200 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2201 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2202 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2203 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2204 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2205
2206 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2207 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2208 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2212 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2213 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2214 output from the Tcl engine.
2215 Intended as a machine interface.
2216 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2217 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2218 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2219 @end deffn
2220
2221 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2222 Specify or query the
2223 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2224 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2225 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2226 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2227 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2228 @end deffn
2229
2230 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2231 @section GDB Configuration
2232 @cindex GDB
2233 @cindex GDB configuration
2234 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2235 The ones listed here are static and global.
2236 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2237 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2238
2239 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2240 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2241 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2242 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2243 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2244 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2245 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2246 @end deffn
2247
2248 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2249 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2250 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2251 vFlash packet is received.
2252 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2253 @end deffn
2254
2255 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2256 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2257 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2258 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2259 for flash programming to work.
2260 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2261 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2262 @end deffn
2263
2264 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2265 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2266 by GDB memory read packets.
2267 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2268 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2269 @end deffn
2270
2271 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2272 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2273 packets report errors or not.
2274 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2275 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2276 @end deffn
2277
2278 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2279 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2280 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2281 @end deffn
2282
2283 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2284 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2285
2286 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2287 @end deffn
2288
2289 @anchor{eventpolling}
2290 @section Event Polling
2291
2292 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2293 where significant events can happen at any time.
2294 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2295 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2296 or to GDB.
2297
2298 Examples of such events include:
2299
2300 @itemize
2301 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2302 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2303 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2304 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2305 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2306 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2307 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2308 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2309 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2310 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2311 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2312 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2313 @end itemize
2314
2315 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2316 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2317 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2318 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2319 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2320
2321 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2322 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2323 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2324 to the various active targets.
2325 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2326 which is normally done in the background.
2327
2328 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2329 Poll the current target for its current state.
2330 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2331 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2332 specific information about the current state is printed.
2333 An optional parameter
2334 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2335
2336 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2337 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2338 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2339 @example
2340 > poll
2341 background polling: on
2342 target state: halted
2343 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2344 current mode: Supervisor
2345 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2346 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2347 >
2348 @end example
2349 @end deffn
2350
2351 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2352 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2353 @cindex config file, interface
2354 @cindex interface config file
2355
2356 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2357 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2358 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2359
2360 @quotation Note
2361 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2362 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2363 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2364 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2365 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2366 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2367 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2368 @end quotation
2369
2370 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2371 through commands in an interface configuration
2372 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2373 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2374
2375 @example
2376 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2377 @end example
2378
2379 These commands tell
2380 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2381 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2382
2383 @example
2384 # jlink interface
2385 adapter driver jlink
2386 @end example
2387
2388 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2389
2390
2391 @section Adapter Configuration
2392
2393 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2394 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2395 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2396
2397 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2398 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2399 target.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2403 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2404 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2405 @end deffn
2406 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2407 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2408 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2409 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2410 the hardware can support.
2411 @end deffn
2412
2413 @anchor{adapter gpio}
2414 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter gpio [ @
2415 @option{tdo} | @option{tdi} | @option{tms} | @option{tck} | @option{trst} | @
2416 @option{swdio} | @option{swdio_dir} | @option{swclk} | @option{srst} | @
2417 @option{led} @
2418 [ @
2419 gpio_number | @option{-chip} chip_number | @
2420 @option{-active-high} | @option{-active-low} | @
2421 @option{-push-pull} | @option{-open-drain} | @option{-open-source} | @
2422 @option{-pull-none} | @option{-pull-up} | @option{-pull-down} | @
2423 @option{-init-inactive} | @option{-init-active} | @option{-init-input} @
2424 ] ]}
2425
2426 Define the GPIO mapping that the adapter will use. The following signals can be
2427 defined:
2428
2429 @itemize @minus
2430 @item @option{tdo}, @option{tdi}, @option{tms}, @option{tck}, @option{trst}:
2431 JTAG transport signals
2432 @item @option{swdio}, @option{swclk}: SWD transport signals
2433 @item @option{swdio_dir}: optional swdio buffer control signal
2434 @item @option{srst}: system reset signal
2435 @item @option{led}: optional activity led
2436
2437 @end itemize
2438
2439 Some adapters require that the GPIO chip number is set in addition to the GPIO
2440 number. The configuration options enable signals to be defined as active-high or
2441 active-low. The output drive mode can be set to push-pull, open-drain or
2442 open-source. Most adapters will have to emulate open-drain or open-source drive
2443 modes by switching between an input and output. Input and output signals can be
2444 instructed to use a pull-up or pull-down resistor, assuming it is supported by
2445 the adaptor driver and hardware. The initial state of outputs may also be set,
2446 "active" state means 1 for active-high outputs and 0 for active-low outputs.
2447 Bidirectional signals may also be initialized as an input. If the swdio signal
2448 is buffered the buffer direction can be controlled with the swdio_dir signal;
2449 the active state means that the buffer should be set as an output with respect
2450 to the adapter. The command options are cumulative with later commands able to
2451 override settings defined by earlier ones. The two commands @command{gpio led 7
2452 -active-high} and @command{gpio led -chip 1 -active-low} sent sequentially are
2453 equivalent to issuing the single command @command{gpio led 7 -chip 1
2454 -active-low}. It is not permissible to set the drive mode or initial state for
2455 signals which are inputs. The drive mode for the srst and trst signals must be
2456 set with the @command{adapter reset_config} command. It is not permissible to
2457 set the initial state of swdio_dir as it is derived from the initial state of
2458 swdio. The command @command{adapter gpio} prints the current configuration for
2459 all GPIOs while the command @command{adapter gpio gpio_name} prints the current
2460 configuration for gpio_name. Not all adapters support this generic GPIO mapping,
2461 some require their own commands to define the GPIOs used. Adapters that support
2462 the generic mapping may not support all of the listed options.
2463 @end deffn
2464
2465 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2466 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2467 @end deffn
2468
2469 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2470 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2471 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2472 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2473 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2474 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2475
2476 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2477 @end deffn
2478
2479 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2480 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2481 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2482 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2483 arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, esp_usb_jtag, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2484 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2485 @end deffn
2486
2487 @section Interface Drivers
2488
2489 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2490 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2491 available at run time.
2492
2493 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2494 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2495 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2496 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2497
2498 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2499 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2500 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2501 @end deffn
2502
2503 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2504 Displays status of RTCK option.
2505 Optionally sets that option first.
2506 @end deffn
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2510 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2511 This has one driver-specific command:
2512
2513 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2514 Logs some status
2515 @end deffn
2516 @end deffn
2517
2518 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2519 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2520 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2521 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2522 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2523 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2524 @end deffn
2525
2526 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2527 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2528 or v2 (USB bulk).
2529
2530 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2531 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2532 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2533 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2534 @example
2535 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2536 @end example
2537 @end deffn
2538
2539 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2540 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2541
2542 @itemize @minus
2543 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2544 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2545 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2546 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2547 @end itemize
2548 @end deffn
2549
2550 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2551 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2552 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2553 interface string or for user class interface.
2554 @end deffn
2555
2556 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2557 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2558 @end deffn
2559
2560 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2561 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2562 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2563
2564 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2565 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2566 are logged.
2567 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2568 @end deffn
2569 @end deffn
2570
2571 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2572 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2573 @end deffn
2574
2575 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2576 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2577 @end deffn
2578
2579 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2580 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2581 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2582
2583 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2584 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2585
2586 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2587 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2588
2589 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2590 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2591 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2592 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2593 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2594 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2595
2596 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2597 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2598 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2599 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2600 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2601
2602 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2603 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2604 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2605 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2606
2607 @itemize @minus
2608 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2609 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2610 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2611 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2612 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2613 switching data and direction as necessary
2614 @end itemize
2615
2616 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2617 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2618
2619 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2620 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2621 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2622 @example
2623 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2624 @end example
2625 @end deffn
2626
2627 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2628 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2629 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2630 during device selection.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2634 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2635 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2639 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2640 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2641 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2642 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2643 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2644 and initially asserted reset signals.
2645 @end deffn
2646
2647 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2648 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2649 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2650 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2651 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2652 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2653 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2654 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2655 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2656 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2657 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2658
2659 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2660 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2661 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2662 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2663 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2664 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2665
2666 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2667 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2668 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2669 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2670 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2671 are always driven by the FTDI.
2672
2673 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2674 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2675 @var{name}.
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2679 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2680 @itemize @minus
2681 @item @option{0}, drive low
2682 @item @option{1}, drive high
2683 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2684 @end itemize
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2688 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2689 @end deffn
2690
2691 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2692 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2693
2694 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2695 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2696 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2697 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2698 @itemize @minus
2699 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2700 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2701 @end itemize
2702 @end deffn
2703
2704 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2705 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2706
2707 @end deffn
2708
2709 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2710 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2711 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2712 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2713
2714 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2715 @itemize @minus
2716 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2717 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2718 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2719 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2720 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2721 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2722 @end itemize
2723
2724 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2725 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2726 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2727 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2728 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2729 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2730 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2731 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2732
2733 FT232R
2734 @itemize @minus
2735 @item bit 7 - RI
2736 @item bit 6 - DCD
2737 @item bit 5 - DSR
2738 @item bit 4 - DTR
2739 @item bit 3 - CTS
2740 @item bit 2 - RTS
2741 @item bit 1 - RXD
2742 @item bit 0 - TXD
2743 @end itemize
2744
2745 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2746 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2747
2748 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2749 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2750 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2751 @end deffn
2752
2753 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2754 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2755 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2756 @end deffn
2757
2758 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2759 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2760 @end deffn
2761
2762 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2763 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2764 @end deffn
2765
2766 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2767 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2768 @end deffn
2769
2770 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2771 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2775 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2776 @end deffn
2777
2778 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2779 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2780 @end deffn
2781
2782 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2783 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2784 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2785 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2786 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2787 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2788 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2789 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2790 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2791 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2792 @end deffn
2793
2794 @end deffn
2795
2796 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2797 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2798 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2799 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2800
2801 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2802 processors which are being simulated.
2803
2804 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2805 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2806 sockets instead of TCP.
2807 @end deffn
2808
2809 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2810 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2811 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2812 @end deffn
2813
2814 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2815 something like:
2816
2817 @example
2818 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2819 remote_bitbang port 3335
2820 remote_bitbang host foobar
2821 @end example
2822
2823 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2824 named mysocket:
2825
2826 @example
2827 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2828 remote_bitbang port 0
2829 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2830 @end example
2831 @end deffn
2832
2833 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2834 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2835 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2836 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2837
2838 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2839 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2840 default values are used.
2841 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2842 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2843 @example
2844 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2845 @end example
2846 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2847 @example
2848 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2849 @end example
2850 @end deffn
2851
2852 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2853 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2854 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2855 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2856 target board.
2857
2858 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2859 @example
2860 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2861 reset_config srst_only
2862 @end example
2863 @end deffn
2864
2865 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2866 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2867 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2868 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2869 @end deffn
2870
2871 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2872 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2873 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2874 @end deffn
2875
2876 @end deffn
2877
2878 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2879 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2880 This has one driver-specific command:
2881
2882 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2883 Display either the address of the I/O port
2884 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2885 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2886 This is a write-once setting.
2887 @end deffn
2888 @end deffn
2889
2890 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2891 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2892 transports.
2893
2894 @quotation Compatibility Note
2895 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2896 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2897 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2898 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2899 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2900 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2901 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2902 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2903 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2904 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2905 @end quotation
2906
2907 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2908 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2909 states.
2910 @end deffn
2911 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2912 Display free device internal memory.
2913 @end deffn
2914 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2915 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2916 command version.
2917 @end deffn
2918 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2919 Display the device configuration.
2920 @end deffn
2921 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2922 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2923 power state.
2924 @end deffn
2925 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2926 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2927 @end deffn
2928 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2929 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2930 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2931 IP configuration.
2932 @end deffn
2933 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2934 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2935 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2936 @end deffn
2937 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2938 Reset the current configuration.
2939 @end deffn
2940 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2941 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2942 @end deffn
2943 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2944 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2945 pairs.
2946
2947 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2948 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2949 @example
2950 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2951 @end example
2952 @end deffn
2953 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2954 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2955 pairs.
2956
2957 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2958 @example
2959 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2960 77a90000
2961 @end example
2962 @end deffn
2963 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2964 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2965 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2966 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2967 the serial number instead, if possible.
2968
2969 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2970 @end deffn
2971 @end deffn
2972
2973 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2974 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2975 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2976 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2977 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2978 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2979 configuration script.
2980
2981 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2982 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2983 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2984 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2985 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2986
2987 Known limitations:
2988 @itemize @bullet
2989 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2990 and 2.7 MHz.
2991 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2992 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2993 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2994 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2995 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2996 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2997 communications with the target.
2998 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2999 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
3000 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
3001 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
3002 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
3003 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
3004 @end itemize
3005
3006 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
3007 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
3008 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
3009 @end deffn
3010
3011 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
3012 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
3013 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
3014 target as a side-effect.
3015 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
3016 @end deffn
3017
3018 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
3019 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
3020 version, and target voltage.
3021 @end deffn
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
3025 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
3026 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
3027 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
3028 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
3029
3030 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
3031 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
3032 This is a write-once setting.
3033 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
3034
3035 @itemize @minus
3036 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
3037 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
3038 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
3039 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
3040 in configuration mode. This is only used to
3041 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
3042 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
3043 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
3044 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
3045 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
3046 some versions of
3047 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
3048 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
3049 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3050 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3051 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3052 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3053 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3054 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3055 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3056 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3057 @end itemize
3058 @end deffn
3059
3060 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
3061 Display either the address of the I/O port
3062 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3063 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3064 This is a write-once setting.
3065
3066 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3067 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3068 you may encounter a problem.
3069 @end deffn
3070
3071 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3072 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3073 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3074 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3075 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3076 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3077
3078 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3079 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3080 @quotation Tip
3081 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3082 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3083 @example
3084 > parport toggling_time 1000
3085 > adapter speed 500
3086 @end example
3087 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3088 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3089 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3090 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3091 large set of samples.
3092 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3093 @example
3094 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3095 @end example
3096 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3097 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3098
3099 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3100 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3101 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3102 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3103 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3104 be conservative.
3105 @end quotation
3106 @end deffn
3107
3108 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3109 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3110 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3111 @end deffn
3112
3113 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3114 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3115
3116 @example
3117 adapter driver parport
3118 parport port 0x278
3119 parport cable wiggler
3120 @end example
3121 @end deffn
3122
3123 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3124 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3125 @end deffn
3126
3127 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3128 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3129 @end deffn
3130
3131 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3132 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3133 @end deffn
3134
3135 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3136 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3137
3138 @quotation Note
3139 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3140 which are not currently documented here.
3141 @end quotation
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @anchor{hla_interface}
3145 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3146 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3147 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3148 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3149
3150 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3151 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3152 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3153 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3154 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3155 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3156
3157 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3158 Currently Not Supported.
3159 @end deffn
3160
3161 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3162 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3163 @end deffn
3164
3165 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3166 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3167 @end deffn
3168
3169 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3170 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3171 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3172
3173 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3174 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3175 ST-LINK server software module}.
3176 @end deffn
3177
3178 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3179 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3180 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3181 @end deffn
3182 @end deffn
3183
3184 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3185 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3186 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3187 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3188 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3189
3190 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3191 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3192 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3193 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3194
3195 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3196 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3197
3198 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3199 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3200 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3201
3202 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3203 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3204 ST-LINK server software module}.
3205
3206 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3207 @end deffn
3208
3209 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3210 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3211 @end deffn
3212
3213 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3214 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3215 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3216
3217 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3218 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3219 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3220 the target's supply voltage.
3221 @example
3222 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3223 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3224 @end example
3225 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3226 @example
3227 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3228 > set n [expr @{[lindex $a 4] + 256 * [lindex $a 5]@}]
3229 > set d [expr @{[lindex $a 0] + 256 * [lindex $a 1]@}]
3230 > echo [expr @{2 * 1.2 * $n / $d@}]
3231 3.24891518738
3232 @end example
3233 @end deffn
3234 @end deffn
3235
3236 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3237 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3238 @end deffn
3239
3240 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3241 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3242 @end deffn
3243
3244 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3245 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3246 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3247 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3248 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3249
3250 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3251 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3252 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3253 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3254 @end deffn
3255
3256 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3257 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3258 version).
3259 @end deffn
3260 @end deffn
3261
3262 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3263 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3264 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3265 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3266 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3267
3268 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3269
3270 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3271 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3272
3273 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3274 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3275
3276 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3277
3278 @end deffn
3279 @end deffn
3280
3281 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3282 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3283 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3284
3285 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3286 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3287 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3288 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3289 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3290 configuration on exit.
3291
3292 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons. GPIO configuration is
3293 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3294
3295 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3296 @file{interface/raspberrypi-gpio-connector.cfg} for pinout.
3297
3298 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3299 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3300 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3301 @end deffn
3302
3303 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_mem_dev} @var{device}
3304 Set the device path for access to the memory mapped GPIO control registers.
3305 Uses @file{/dev/gpiomem} by default, this is also the preferred option with
3306 respect to system security.
3307 If overridden to @file{/dev/mem}:
3308 @itemize @minus
3309 @item OpenOCD needs @code{cap_sys_rawio} or run as root to open @file{/dev/mem}.
3310 Please be aware of security issues imposed by running OpenOCD with
3311 elevated user rights and by @file{/dev/mem} itself.
3312 @item correct @command{peripheral_base} must be configured.
3313 @item GPIO 0-27 pads are set to the limited slew rate
3314 and drive strength is reduced to 4 mA (2 mA on RPi 4).
3315 @end itemize
3316
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3320 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs.
3321 Ignored if @file{/dev/gpiomem} is used. For the RPi1, use
3322 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3323 list can be found in the
3324 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3325 @end deffn
3326
3327 @end deffn
3328
3329 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3330 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3331 of the one which is most popular.
3332
3333 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3334
3335 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3336 pinout.
3337
3338 @end deffn
3339
3340
3341 @deffn {Interface Driver} {am335xgpio} The AM335x SoC is present in BeagleBone
3342 Black and BeagleBone Green single-board computers which expose some of the GPIOs
3343 on the two expansion headers.
3344
3345 For maximum performance the driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral
3346 registers directly. The memory mapping requires read and write permission to
3347 kernel memory; if /dev/gpiomem exists it will be used, otherwise /dev/mem will
3348 be used. The driver restores the GPIO state on exit.
3349
3350 All four GPIO ports are available. GPIO configuration is handled by the generic
3351 command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}.
3352
3353 @deffn {Config Command} {am335xgpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3354 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified
3355 speed_coeff defaults to 600000 and speed_offset defaults to 575.
3356 @end deffn
3357
3358 See @file{interface/beaglebone-swd-native.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3359
3360 @end deffn
3361
3362
3363 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3364 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel
3365 version v4.6. The driver emulates either JTAG or SWD transport through
3366 bitbanging. There are no driver-specific commands, all GPIO configuration is
3367 handled by the generic command @ref{adapter gpio, @command{adapter gpio}}. This
3368 driver supports the resistor pull options provided by the @command{adapter gpio}
3369 command but the underlying hardware may not be able to support them.
3370
3371 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample configuration file.
3372 @end deffn
3373
3374
3375 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3376 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3377 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3378
3379 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3380 @end deffn
3381
3382
3383 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3384 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3385 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3386
3387 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3388 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3389 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3390
3391 @itemize @minus
3392 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3393 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3394 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3395 @end itemize
3396 @end deffn
3397
3398 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3399 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3400 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3401 @end deffn
3402 @end deffn
3403
3404
3405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vdebug}
3406 Cadence Virtual Debug Interface driver.
3407
3408 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug server} host:port
3409 Specifies the host and TCP port number where the vdebug server runs.
3410 @end deffn
3411
3412 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug batching} value
3413 Specifies the batching method for the vdebug request. Possible values are
3414 0 for no batching
3415 1 or wr to batch write transactions together (default)
3416 2 or rw to batch both read and write transactions
3417 @end deffn
3418
3419 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug polling} min max
3420 Takes two values, representing the polling interval in ms. Lower values mean faster
3421 debugger responsiveness, but lower emulation performance. The minimum should be
3422 around 10, maximum should not exceed 1000, which is the default gdb and keepalive
3423 timeout value.
3424 @end deffn
3425
3426 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug bfm_path} path clk_period
3427 Specifies the hierarchical path and input clk period of the vdebug BFM in the design.
3428 The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation top.inst.inst
3429 The clock period must include the unit, for instance 40ns.
3430 @end deffn
3431
3432 @deffn {Config Command} {vdebug mem_path} path base size
3433 Specifies the hierarchical path to the design memory instance for backdoor access.
3434 Up to 4 memories can be specified. The hierarchical path uses Verilog notation.
3435 The base specifies start address in the design address space, size its size in bytes.
3436 Both values can use hexadecimal notation with prefix 0x.
3437 @end deffn
3438 @end deffn
3439
3440 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3441 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3442 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3443 DPI server interface.
3444
3445 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3446 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3447 @end deffn
3448
3449 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3450 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3451 @end deffn
3452 @end deffn
3453
3454
3455 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3456
3457 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3458 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3459
3460 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3461 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3462
3463 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3464 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3465 @example
3466 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3467 @end example
3468 @end deffn
3469
3470 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3471 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3472 @example
3473 buspirate speed normal
3474 @end example
3475 @end deffn
3476
3477 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3478 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3479 @itemize @minus
3480 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3481 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3482 @end itemize
3483 For example:
3484 @example
3485 buspirate mode normal
3486 @end example
3487 @end deffn
3488
3489 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3490 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3491 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3492 For example:
3493 @example
3494 buspirate pullup 0
3495 @end example
3496 @end deffn
3497
3498 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3499 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3500 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3501 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3502 @example
3503 buspirate vreg 0
3504 @end example
3505 @end deffn
3506
3507 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3508 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3509 @end deffn
3510 @example
3511 buspirate led 1
3512 @end example
3513
3514 @end deffn
3515
3516 @deffn {Interface Driver} {esp_usb_jtag}
3517 Espressif JTAG driver to communicate with ESP32-C3, ESP32-S3 chips and ESP USB Bridge board using OpenOCD.
3518 These chips have built-in JTAG circuitry and can be debugged without any additional hardware.
3519 Only an USB cable connected to the D+/D- pins is necessary.
3520
3521 @deffn {Command} {espusbjtag tdo}
3522 Returns the current state of the TDO line
3523 @end deffn
3524
3525 @deffn {Command} {espusbjtag setio} setio
3526 Manually set the status of the output lines with the order of (tdi tms tck trst srst)
3527 @example
3528 espusbjtag setio 0 1 0 1 0
3529 @end example
3530 @end deffn
3531
3532 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag vid_pid} vid_pid
3533 Set vendor ID and product ID for the ESP usb jtag driver
3534 @example
3535 espusbjtag vid_pid 0x303a 0x1001
3536 @end example
3537 @end deffn
3538
3539 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag caps_descriptor} caps_descriptor
3540 Set the jtag descriptor to read capabilities of ESP usb jtag driver
3541 @example
3542 espusbjtag caps_descriptor 0x2000
3543 @end example
3544 @end deffn
3545
3546 @deffn {Config Command} {espusbjtag chip_id} chip_id
3547 Set chip id to transfer to the ESP USB bridge board
3548 @example
3549 espusbjtag chip_id 1
3550 @end example
3551 @end deffn
3552
3553 @end deffn
3554
3555 @section Transport Configuration
3556 @cindex Transport
3557 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3558 and the debug adapter you are using,
3559 several transports may be available to
3560 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3561 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3562 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3563 version of OpenOCD.
3564 @end deffn
3565
3566 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3567 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3568
3569 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3570 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3571 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3572 adapter's driver).
3573
3574 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3575 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3576 supported by the debug adapter.
3577
3578 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3579 transport, if any.
3580 @end deffn
3581
3582 @subsection JTAG Transport
3583 @cindex JTAG
3584 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3585 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3586 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3587 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3588 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3589 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3590
3591 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3592 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3593 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3594 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3595 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3596
3597 @subsection SWD Transport
3598 @cindex SWD
3599 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3600 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3601 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3602 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3603 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3604 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3605 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3606
3607 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3608 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3609 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3610 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3611 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3612
3613 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3614 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3615 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3616 expected to change.
3617 @end deffn
3618
3619 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3620 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3621 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3622 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3623 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3624 DAPs are created.
3625
3626 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3627 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3628 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3629
3630 @subsection SPI Transport
3631 @cindex SPI
3632 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3633 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3634 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3635 solution for flash programming.
3636
3637 @anchor{swimtransport}
3638 @subsection SWIM Transport
3639 @cindex SWIM
3640 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3641 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3642 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3643 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3644
3645 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3646
3647 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3648
3649 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3650 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3651 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3652 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3653 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3654
3655 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3656 @section JTAG Speed
3657 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3658 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3659 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3660 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3661 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3662 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3663 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3664 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3665 power management software that may be active.
3666
3667 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3668 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3669 target event handler.
3670 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3671 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3672 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3673 sets up those clocks).
3674 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3675 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3676 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3677 in the target config file.
3678 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3679 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3680 config file instead.
3681 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3682 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3683 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3684
3685 @example
3686 jtag_rclk 3000
3687 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3688 @end example
3689
3690 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3691 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3692 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3693 may not be the fastest solution.
3694
3695 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3696 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3697 which support adaptive clocking.
3698
3699 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3700 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3701 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3702 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3703 than the speed specified.
3704
3705 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3706 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3707 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3708 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3709
3710 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3711 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3712 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3713 JTAG clocking after setup.
3714 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3715 If the interface device can not
3716 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3717 @end deffn
3718
3719 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3720 @cindex adaptive clocking
3721 @cindex RTCK
3722 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3723 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3724 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3725 @example
3726 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3727 jtag_rclk 3000
3728 @end example
3729 @end defun
3730
3731 @node Reset Configuration
3732 @chapter Reset Configuration
3733 @cindex Reset Configuration
3734
3735 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3736 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3737 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3738 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3739 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3740 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3741 Please see the various board files for examples.
3742
3743 @quotation Note
3744 To maintainers and integrators:
3745 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3746 Normally the board configuration file
3747 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3748 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3749
3750 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3751 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3752 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3753 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3754 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3755 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3756 @end quotation
3757
3758 @section Types of Reset
3759
3760 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3761 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3762 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3763
3764 @itemize @bullet
3765 @item
3766 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3767 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3768 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3769 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3770 @item
3771 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3772 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3773 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3774 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3775 @item
3776 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3777 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3778 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3779 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3780 @item
3781 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3782 several other types of reset.
3783 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3784 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3785 There may be individual module resets.
3786 @end itemize
3787
3788 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3789 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3790 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3791 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3792 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3793 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3794 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3795 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3796 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3797
3798 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3799 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3800
3801 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3802 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3803 common issues are:
3804
3805 @itemize @bullet
3806
3807 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3808 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3809 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3810 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3811 when either of those signals is not connected.
3812 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3813 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3814 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3815 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3816
3817 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3818 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3819 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3820 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3821
3822 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3823 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3824 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3825 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3826 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3827 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3828 hardware debouncing.
3829 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3830 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3831
3832 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3833 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3834 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3835 to use push/pull output drivers.
3836 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3837 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3838 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3839 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3840
3841 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3842 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3843 issues (not limited to errata).
3844 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3845 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3846 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3847 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3848 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3849 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3850 @end itemize
3851
3852 There can also be other issues.
3853 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3854 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3855 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3856 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3857 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3858 Agreement (NDA).
3859
3860 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3861 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3862 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3863
3864 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3865 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3866
3867 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3868
3869 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3870 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3871 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3872 allowing it to be deasserted.
3873 @end deffn
3874
3875 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3876 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3877 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3878 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3879 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3880 @end deffn
3881
3882 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3883 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3884 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3885 allowing it to be deasserted.
3886 @end deffn
3887
3888 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3889 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3890 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3891 @end deffn
3892
3893 @anchor{reset_config}
3894 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3895 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3896 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3897 configuration scripts.
3898
3899 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3900 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3901 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3902 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3903 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3904 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3905 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3906 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3907
3908 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3909 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3910 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3911 -- may be specified at a time.
3912 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3913 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3914 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3915 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3916 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3917
3918 @itemize
3919 @item
3920 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3921 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3922 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3923 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3924 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3925
3926 @quotation Tip
3927 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3928 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3929 @end quotation
3930
3931 @item
3932 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3933 signal implementations.
3934 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3935 indicating everything behaves normally.
3936 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3937 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3938 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3939 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3940 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3941 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3942 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3943
3944 @item
3945 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3946 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3947 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3948 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3949 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3950 while SRST is asserted.
3951 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3952 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3953
3954 @item
3955 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3956 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3957 is required to use this option.
3958 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3959 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3960 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3961 be asserted before any target connection.
3962 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3963 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3964 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3965 @end itemize
3966
3967 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3968 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3969 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3970 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3971 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3972
3973 @itemize
3974 @item
3975 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3976 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3977 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3978 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3979
3980 @item
3981 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3982 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3983 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3984 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3985 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3986 @end itemize
3987 @end deffn
3988
3989 @section Custom Reset Handling
3990 @cindex events
3991
3992 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3993 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3994 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3995 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3996 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3997 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3998
3999 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
4000 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
4001 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
4002 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
4003 want to reset everything at once.
4004
4005 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
4006 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
4007 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
4008 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
4009 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
4010 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
4011 needs special attention.
4012
4013 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
4014 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
4015 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
4016 to find a sequence of operations that works.
4017 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
4018 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
4019 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
4020 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
4021 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
4022
4023 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
4024 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
4025 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
4026 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
4027 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
4028
4029 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
4030 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
4031 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
4032 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
4033 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
4034 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
4035 low level reset command (@option{halt},
4036 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
4037 or potentially some other value.
4038
4039 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
4040 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
4041 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
4042 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
4043 (or their associated targets)
4044 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
4045
4046 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
4047 they return.
4048 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
4049 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
4050 @end deffn
4051
4052 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
4053 This validates the scan chain using just the four
4054 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
4055 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
4056 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
4057 matches the TAPs it can observe.
4058 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
4059 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
4060 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
4061 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
4062 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
4063 @end deffn
4064
4065 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
4066 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
4067 everything on the JTAG scan chain
4068 (and anything else connected to SRST).
4069 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
4070 @end deffn
4071
4072
4073 @node TAP Declaration
4074 @chapter TAP Declaration
4075 @cindex TAP declaration
4076 @cindex TAP configuration
4077
4078 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
4079 TAPs serve many roles, including:
4080
4081 @itemize @bullet
4082 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
4083 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
4084 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
4085 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
4086 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
4087 start running that code.
4088 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
4089 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
4090 and missing connections.
4091 @end itemize
4092
4093 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
4094 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
4095 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
4096 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
4097 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
4098
4099 @section Scan Chains
4100 @cindex scan chain
4101
4102 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
4103 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
4104 They also need to be added to
4105 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
4106 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
4107 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
4108 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
4109 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
4110 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
4111 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
4112 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
4113
4114 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
4115 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
4116 command, presented in the next chapter.
4117 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
4118 debugging targets.)
4119 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
4120
4121 @verbatim
4122 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
4123 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
4124 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
4125 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
4126 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
4127 @end verbatim
4128
4129 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
4130 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4131 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4132 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4133 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4134 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4135 until they are told to do so.
4136
4137 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4138 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4139 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4140 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4141
4142 @example
4143 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4144 @end example
4145
4146 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4147 by a given chip.
4148 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4149 and so forth.
4150 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4151 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4152 both inside a single chip and between them.
4153 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4154
4155 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4156 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4157 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4158 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4159 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4160 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4161 includes commands something like this:
4162
4163 @example
4164 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4165 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4166 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4167 @end example
4168
4169 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4170 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4171 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4172
4173 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4174 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4175 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4176 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4177 @example
4178 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4179 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4180 @}
4181 @end example
4182 @end deffn
4183
4184 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4185 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4186 and their status.
4187 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4188 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4189 but systems with a JTAG router can
4190 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4191 @end deffn
4192
4193 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4194 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4195
4196 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4197 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4198
4199 @section TAP Names
4200 @cindex dotted name
4201
4202 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4203 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4204 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4205 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4206 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4207 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4208 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4209 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4210
4211 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4212 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4213 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4214
4215 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4216
4217 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4218 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4219 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4220
4221 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4222 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4223 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4224 overridable.
4225
4226 @cindex TAP naming convention
4227 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4228 and should follow this convention:
4229
4230 @itemize @bullet
4231 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4232 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4233 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4234 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4235 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4236 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4237 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4238 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4239 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4240 with a single TAP;
4241 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4242 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4243 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4244 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4245 @end itemize
4246
4247 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4248
4249 @itemize @bullet
4250 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4251 @*The length in bits of the
4252 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4253 @end itemize
4254
4255 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4256
4257 @itemize @bullet
4258 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4259 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4260 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4261 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4262 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4263 (the TAP is linked in).
4264 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4265 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4266 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4267 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4268 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4269 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4270 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4271 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4272 values that were found but not included in the list.
4273
4274 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4275 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4276 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4277 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4278 hardware to find these values.
4279 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4280 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4281 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4282 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4283 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4284 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4285 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4286 @item @code{-ignore-bypass}
4287 @*Specify this to ignore the 'bypass' bit of the idcode. Some vendor put
4288 an invalid idcode regarding this bit. Specify this to ignore this bit and
4289 to not consider this tap in bypass mode.
4290 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4291 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4292 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4293 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4294 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4295 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4296 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4297 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4298 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4299 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4300 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4301 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4302 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4303 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4304 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4305 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4306 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4307 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4308 @end itemize
4309 @end deffn
4310
4311 @section Other TAP commands
4312
4313 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4314 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4315 @end deffn
4316
4317 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4318 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4319 At this writing this TAP attribute
4320 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4321 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4322 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4323 See the next section for information about the available events.
4324
4325 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4326 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4327 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @section TAP Events
4331 @cindex events
4332 @cindex TAP events
4333
4334 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4335 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4336 The other applies to debugger targets,
4337 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4338
4339 The TAP events currently defined are:
4340
4341 @itemize @bullet
4342 @item @b{post-reset}
4343 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4344 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4345 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4346 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4347 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4348
4349 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4350 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4351 of any particular target.
4352 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4353 @item @b{setup}
4354 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4355 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4356 @item @b{tap-disable}
4357 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4358 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4359 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4360 @item @b{tap-enable}
4361 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4362 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4363 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4364 @end itemize
4365
4366 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4367 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4368 contents to be accurate), you might:
4369
4370 @example
4371 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4372 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4373 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4374 @}
4375 @end example
4376
4377
4378 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4379 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4380 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4381 @cindex jrc
4382
4383 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4384 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4385 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4386 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4387 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4388
4389 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4390 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4391 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4392 be visible.
4393 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4394 ignores, such as:
4395
4396 @itemize
4397 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4398 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4399 TAPs receive new instructions.
4400 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4401 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4402 @end itemize
4403
4404 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4405 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4406 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4407 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4408
4409 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4410 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4411
4412 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4413 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4414 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4415 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4416 should define TAP event handlers using
4417 code that looks something like this:
4418
4419 @example
4420 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4421 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4422 @}
4423 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4424 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4425 @}
4426 @end example
4427
4428 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4429
4430 @example
4431 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4432 @end example
4433
4434 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4435 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4436 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4437 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4438
4439 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4440 If necessary, disables the tap
4441 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4442 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4443 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4444 and "0" if it is disabled.
4445 @end deffn
4446
4447 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4448 If necessary, enables the tap
4449 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4450 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4451 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4452 and "0" if it is disabled.
4453 @end deffn
4454
4455 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4456 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4457 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4458 and "0" if it is disabled.
4459
4460 @quotation Note
4461 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4462 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4463 @end quotation
4464 @end deffn
4465
4466 @anchor{autoprobing}
4467 @section Autoprobing
4468 @cindex autoprobe
4469 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4470
4471 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4472 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4473 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4474 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4475
4476 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4477 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4478 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4479 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4480 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4481 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4482 right when they come out of reset).
4483
4484 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4485
4486 @example
4487 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4488 reset_config trst_and_srst
4489 jtag_rclk 8
4490 @end example
4491
4492 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4493 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4494
4495 @enumerate
4496 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4497 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4498 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4499 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4500 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4501 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4502 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4503 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4504 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4505 that is discovered.
4506 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4507 register, it will report it.
4508 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4509 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4510 @end enumerate
4511
4512 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4513 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4514 that's a bit more complex:
4515
4516 @example
4517 clock speed 8 kHz
4518 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4519 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4520 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4521 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4522 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4523 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4524 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4525 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4526 @end example
4527
4528 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4529 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4530 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4531 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4532 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4533 and so forth.
4534
4535 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4536 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4537 @cindex DAP declaration
4538
4539 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4540 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4541 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4542 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4543 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4544
4545 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4546
4547 @anchor{dap_create}
4548 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4549 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4550 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4551 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4552 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4553
4554 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4555
4556 @itemize @bullet
4557 @item @code{-adiv5}
4558 Specify that it's an ADIv5 DAP. This is the default if not specified.
4559 @item @code{-adiv6}
4560 Specify that it's an ADIv6 DAP.
4561 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4562 Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4563 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4564 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4565 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4566
4567 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4568 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4569 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4570 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4571 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4572 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4573
4574 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4575 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4576 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4577 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4578 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4579 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4580 @end itemize
4581 @end deffn
4582
4583 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4584 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4585 for TCL scripting.
4586 @end deffn
4587
4588 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4589 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4590 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4591 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4592 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4593 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4594 @end deffn
4595
4596 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4597 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4598 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4599 initialization, too.
4600 @end deffn
4601
4602 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4603
4604 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [@var{num}|@option{root}]
4605 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4606 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4607 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4608 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4609 With ADIv6 only, @option{root} specifies the root ROM table.
4610 @end deffn
4611
4612 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4613 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4614 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4615 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4616 @end deffn
4617
4618 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4619 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4620 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4621 or set a new value @var{value}.
4622 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4623 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_num} is the base address of the AP.
4624 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4625 @end deffn
4626
4627 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4628 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4629 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4630 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4631 @end deffn
4632
4633 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4634 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4635 value @var{value}.
4636
4637 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4638 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4639 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4640
4641 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4642 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4643 @end deffn
4644
4645 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4646 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4647 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4648 On ADIv5 DAP @var{num} is the numeric index of the AP.
4649 On ADIv6 DAP @var{num} is the base address of the AP.
4650 @end deffn
4651
4652 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4653 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4654 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4655 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4656 @end deffn
4657
4658 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4659 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4660
4661 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4662 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4663 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4664 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4665 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4666 for details.
4667
4668 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4669 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4670 the pattern:
4671 @example
4672 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4673 @end example
4674
4675 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4676 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4677 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4678 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4679 @example
4680 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr @{1 << 27@}]
4681 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4682 @end example
4683
4684 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4685 @example
4686 set CSW_SPROT [expr @{1 << 30@}]
4687 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4688 @end example
4689
4690 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4691 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4692
4693 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4694 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4695 example with a proper dap name:
4696 @example
4697 xxx.dap apcsw default
4698 @end example
4699 @end deffn
4700
4701 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4702 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4703 Disabled by default
4704 @end deffn
4705
4706 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name nu_npcx_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4707 Set/get quirks mode for Nuvoton NPCX/NPCD MCU families
4708 Disabled by default
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 @node CPU Configuration
4712 @chapter CPU Configuration
4713 @cindex GDB target
4714
4715 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4716 You can also access these targets without GDB
4717 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4718 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4719 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4720 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4721
4722 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4723 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4724
4725 @section Target List
4726 @cindex target, current
4727 @cindex target, list
4728
4729 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4730 where each member has a name.
4731 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4732 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4733 (plural!) command.
4734 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4735 look like with more than one:
4736 @verbatim
4737 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4738 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4739 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4740 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4741 @end verbatim
4742
4743 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4744 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4745 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4746 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4747 space seen by that current target.
4748 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4749 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4750 are examples; and there are many more.
4751
4752 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4753
4754 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4755 Returns the name of the current target.
4756 @end deffn
4757
4758 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4759 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4760 @example
4761 foreach t [target names] @{
4762 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4763 @}
4764 @end example
4765 @end deffn
4766
4767 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4768 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4769
4770 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4771 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4772 command names are singular.}
4773
4774 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4775 targets in a user friendly form.
4776
4777 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4778 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4779 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4780 @end deffn
4781
4782 @section Target CPU Types
4783 @cindex target type
4784 @cindex CPU type
4785
4786 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4787 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4788 when calling @command{target create}.
4789 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4790 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4791 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4792 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4793 what core-specific commands may be available
4794 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4795 and more.
4796
4797 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4798 since there's a command to list them.
4799
4800 @anchor{targettypes}
4801 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4802 Lists all supported target types.
4803 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4804
4805 @itemize @bullet
4806 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4807 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4808 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4809 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4810 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4811 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4812 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4813 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4814 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4815 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4816 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4817 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4818 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4819 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4820 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4821 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4822 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4823 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4824 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4825 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4826 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4827 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4828 @item @code{esp32} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4829 @item @code{esp32s2} -- this is an Espressif SoC with single Xtensa core.
4830 @item @code{esp32s3} -- this is an Espressif SoC with dual Xtensa cores.
4831 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4832 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4833 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4834 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4835 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4836 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4837 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4838 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4839 support for new CPUs.
4840 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4841 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4842 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4843 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4844 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4845 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4846 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4847 @itemize @minus
4848 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4849 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4850 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4851 @end itemize
4852 And two debug interfaces cores:
4853 @itemize @minus
4854 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4855 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4856 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4857 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4858 @end itemize
4859 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4860 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4861 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4862 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4863 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4864 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4865 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4866 @item @code{xtensa} -- this is a generic Cadence/Tensilica Xtensa core.
4867 @end itemize
4868 @end deffn
4869
4870 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4871 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4872 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4873 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4874 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4875 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4876 reflect design generations;
4877 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4878 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4879
4880 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4881 @section Target Configuration
4882
4883 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4884 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4885 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4886 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4887 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4888
4889 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4890 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4891 optional parts.
4892 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4893 command, created as part of target creation.
4894
4895 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4896 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4897 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4898 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4899 to be much more board-specific.
4900 The key steps you use might look something like this
4901
4902 @example
4903 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4904 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4905 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4906 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4907 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4908 @end example
4909
4910 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4911 on-chip SRAM.
4912 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4913 writes to target memory;
4914 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4915 GDB memory checksumming;
4916 and more.
4917
4918 @quotation Warning
4919 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4920 inaccessible when application code
4921 (such as an operating system)
4922 enables or disables the MMU.
4923 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4924 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4925 easy access to other addresses needed.
4926 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4927 @end quotation
4928
4929 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4930 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4931 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4932 controllers.
4933 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4934 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4935 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4936
4937 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4938 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4939 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4940 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4941 purposes including additional configuration.
4942
4943 @itemize @bullet
4944 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4945 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4946 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4947 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4948
4949 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4950 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4951 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4952 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4953 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4954 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4955 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4956
4957 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4958 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4959 @end itemize
4960 @end deffn
4961
4962 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4963 The options accepted by this command may also be
4964 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4965 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4966 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4967
4968 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4969 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4970 and changing its endianness.
4971
4972 @itemize @bullet
4973
4974 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4975 used to access this target.
4976
4977 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4978 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4979 create and manage DAP instances.
4980
4981 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4982 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4983
4984 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4985 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4986 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4987 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4988 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4989 same event name assigns only one handler.
4990
4991 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4992 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4993
4994 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4995 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4996 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4997 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4998 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4999 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
5000 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
5001
5002 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
5003 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
5004 or virtual address is being used.
5005
5006 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
5007 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
5008
5009 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
5010 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
5011 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
5012 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
5013 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
5014
5015 @anchor{rtostype}
5016 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
5017 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{none}, @option{eCos},
5018 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
5019 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
5020 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}, @option{rtkernel}
5021 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
5022
5023 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
5024 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
5025 access the target for debugging.
5026
5027 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target.
5028 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5029 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
5030 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
5031 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
5032
5033 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
5034 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
5035 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
5036 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
5037 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
5038
5039 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
5040 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
5041 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
5042 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
5043 command @command{gdb_port}.
5044 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
5045
5046 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
5047 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
5048 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
5049 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
5050 @end itemize
5051 @end deffn
5052
5053 @section Other $target_name Commands
5054 @cindex object command
5055
5056 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
5057 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
5058
5059 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
5060 Once a button is created a button
5061 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
5062 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
5063 configure it like this:
5064
5065 @example
5066 # Create
5067 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
5068 # Modify
5069 .foobar configure -foreground blue
5070 # Query
5071 set x [.foobar cget -background]
5072 # Report
5073 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
5074 @end example
5075
5076 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
5077 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
5078
5079 @example
5080 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
5081 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
5082 @end example
5083
5084 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
5085
5086 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
5087 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
5088 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
5089 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
5090 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
5091 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
5092 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
5093 They are not otherwise documented here.
5094 @end deffn
5095
5096 @deffn {Command} {$target_name set_reg} dict
5097 Set register values of the target.
5098
5099 @itemize
5100 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
5101 @end itemize
5102
5103 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
5104 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
5105
5106 @example
5107 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
5108 @end example
5109 @end deffn
5110
5111 @deffn {Command} {$target_name get_reg} [-force] list
5112 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
5113 of register names and values.
5114 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
5115 target, bypassing any caching.
5116
5117 @itemize
5118 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
5119 @end itemize
5120
5121 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
5122 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
5123
5124 @example
5125 get_reg @{pc sp@}
5126 @end example
5127 @end deffn
5128
5129 @deffn {Command} {$target_name write_memory} address width data ['phys']
5130 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
5131 script.
5132
5133 @itemize
5134 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5135 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5136 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
5137 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5138 @end itemize
5139
5140 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
5141 memory at address 0x20000000:
5142
5143 @example
5144 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
5145 @end example
5146 @end deffn
5147
5148 @deffn {Command} {$target_name read_memory} address width count ['phys']
5149 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
5150 script.
5151 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
5152
5153 @itemize
5154 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
5155 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
5156 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
5157 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
5158 @end itemize
5159
5160 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
5161 memory at address 0x20000000:
5162
5163 @example
5164 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
5165 @end example
5166 @end deffn
5167
5168 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
5169 Each configuration parameter accepted by
5170 @command{$target_name configure}
5171 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
5172 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
5173 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
5174 There are a few special cases:
5175
5176 @itemize @bullet
5177 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
5178 event named @var{event_name}.
5179 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
5180 two parameters.
5181 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
5182 This is a special case because this is set using
5183 @command{target create} and can't be changed
5184 using @command{$target_name configure}.
5185 @end itemize
5186
5187 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
5188 all the targets you might use something like this:
5189
5190 @example
5191 foreach name [target names] @{
5192 set y [$name cget -endian]
5193 set z [$name cget -type]
5194 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
5195 $x $name $y $z]
5196 @}
5197 @end example
5198 @end deffn
5199
5200 @anchor{targetcurstate}
5201 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
5202 Displays the current target state:
5203 @code{debug-running},
5204 @code{halted},
5205 @code{reset},
5206 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
5207 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
5208 @end deffn
5209
5210 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5211 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5212 currently associated with this target.
5213 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5214 @end deffn
5215
5216 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5217 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5218 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5219 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5220 @end deffn
5221
5222 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5223 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5224 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5225 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5226 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5227 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5228 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5229 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5230 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5231 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5232 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5233 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5234 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5235 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
5236 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
5237 @end deffn
5238
5239 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5240 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5241 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5242 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5243 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5244 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5245 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5246 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5247 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5248 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5249 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5250 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5251 @end deffn
5252
5253 @anchor{targetevents}
5254 @section Target Events
5255 @cindex target events
5256 @cindex events
5257 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5258 For example:
5259 @itemize @bullet
5260 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5261 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5262 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5263 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5264 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5265 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5266 to set up system clocks or
5267 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5268 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5269 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5270 @end itemize
5271
5272 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5273 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5274 @command{target create ... -event}.
5275
5276 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5277 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5278 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5279
5280 @example
5281 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5282 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5283 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5284 @}
5285 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5286 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5287 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5288 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5289 @}
5290 @end example
5291
5292 The following target events are defined:
5293
5294 @itemize @bullet
5295 @item @b{debug-halted}
5296 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5297 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5298 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5299 @item @b{early-halted}
5300 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5301 @item @b{examine-start}
5302 @* Before target examine is called.
5303 @item @b{examine-end}
5304 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5305 @item @b{examine-fail}
5306 @* After target examine fails.
5307 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5308 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5309 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5310 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5311 connect GDB to running target.
5312 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5313 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5314 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5315 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5316 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5317 is in RAM or read only memory.
5318 Default is @code{halt}
5319 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5320 @* When GDB disconnects
5321 @item @b{gdb-end}
5322 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5323 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5324 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5325 @code{reset init})
5326 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5327 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5328 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5329 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5330 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5331 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5332 @item @b{gdb-start}
5333 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5334 @item @b{halted}
5335 @* The target has halted
5336 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5337 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5338 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5339 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5340 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5341 @item @b{reset-assert}
5342 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5343 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5344 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5345 it instead of asserting SRST.
5346 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5347 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5348 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5349 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5350 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5351 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5352 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5353 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5354 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5355 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5356 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5357 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5358 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5359 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5360 released on the scan chain.
5361 @item @b{reset-end}
5362 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5363 @item @b{reset-init}
5364 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5365 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5366
5367 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5368 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5369 multiplexing, and so on.
5370 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5371 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5372 @item @b{reset-start}
5373 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5374 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5375
5376 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5377 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5378 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5379 @item @b{resume-start}
5380 @* Before any target is resumed
5381 @item @b{resume-end}
5382 @* After all targets have resumed
5383 @item @b{resumed}
5384 @* Target has resumed
5385 @item @b{step-start}
5386 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5387 @item @b{step-end}
5388 @* After single-step has completed
5389 @item @b{trace-config}
5390 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5391 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x100}
5392 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x100
5393 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x101}
5394 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x101
5395 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x102}
5396 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x102
5397 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x103}
5398 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x103
5399 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x104}
5400 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x104
5401 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x105}
5402 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x105
5403 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x106}
5404 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x106
5405 @item @b{semihosting-user-cmd-0x107}
5406 @* The target made a semihosting call with user-defined operation number 0x107
5407 @end itemize
5408
5409 @quotation Note
5410 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5411 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5412 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5413 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5414 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5415 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5416 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5417 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5418 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5419 check if the core has changed status.
5420 @end quotation
5421
5422 @node Flash Commands
5423 @chapter Flash Commands
5424
5425 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5426 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5427 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5428 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5429 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5430 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5431 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5432 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5433 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5434
5435 Flash Steps:
5436 @enumerate
5437 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5438 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5439 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5440 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5441 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5442 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5443 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5444 @item GDB Flashing
5445 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5446 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5447 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5448 @end enumerate
5449
5450 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5451 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5452 so that it can't boot.
5453 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5454 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5455
5456 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5457 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5458 @cindex flash configuration
5459
5460 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5461 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5462 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5463 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5464 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5465 see the driver-specific documentation.
5466
5467 @itemize @bullet
5468 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5469 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5470 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5471 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5472 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5473 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5474 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5475 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5476 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5477 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5478 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5479 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5480 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5481 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5482 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5483 commands to the flash controller.
5484 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5485 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5486 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5487 for more information.
5488 @end itemize
5489 @quotation Note
5490 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5491 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5492 @end quotation
5493 @end deffn
5494
5495 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5496 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5497 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5498 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5499 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5500 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5501 @end deffn
5502
5503 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5504 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5505 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5506 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5507 @end deffn
5508
5509 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5510 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5511 depends on the flash type.
5512 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5513 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5514 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5515 but most don't bother.
5516 @end deffn
5517
5518 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5519
5520 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5521 begins.
5522
5523 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5524 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5525 until the programming session is finished.
5526
5527 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5528 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5529
5530 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5531
5532 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5533 @cindex flash erasing
5534 @cindex flash reading
5535 @cindex flash writing
5536 @cindex flash programming
5537 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5538
5539 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5540 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5541 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5542 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5543 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5544
5545 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5546 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5547 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5548 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5549 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5550
5551 @quotation Note
5552 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5553 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5554 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5555 back to a flash bank.
5556 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5557 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5558 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5559 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5560 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5561 @end quotation
5562
5563 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5564 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5565 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5566 disabled first.
5567 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5568 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5569 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5570
5571 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5572 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5573 up to and including @var{last}.
5574 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5575 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5576 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5577 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5578 @end deffn
5579
5580 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5581 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5582 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5583 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5584 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5585 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5586 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5587 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5588 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5589 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5590 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5591 before erase starts.
5592 @end deffn
5593
5594 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5595 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5596 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5597 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5598 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5599 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5600 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5601 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5602 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5603 before issuing this command.
5604 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5605 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5606 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5607 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5608 @end deffn
5609 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5610
5611 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5612 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5613 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5614 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5615 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5616 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5617 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5618 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5619 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5620 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5621 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5622 @end deffn
5623
5624 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5625 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5626 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5627 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5628 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5629 @end deffn
5630
5631 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5632 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5633 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5634 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5635 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5636 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5640 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5641 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5642 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5643 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5644 @end deffn
5645
5646 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5647 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5648 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5649 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5650 to the base address for each section in the image.
5651 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5652 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5653 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5654 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5655 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5656 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5657 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5658 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5659 each image section.
5660
5661 @quotation Warning
5662 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5663 data you want to preserve.
5664 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5665 sections might be erased with no notice.
5666 @itemize
5667 @item
5668 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5669 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5670 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5671 @item
5672 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5673 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5674 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5675 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5676 @end itemize
5677 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5678 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5679 @end quotation
5680
5681 @end deffn
5682
5683 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5684 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5685 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5686 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5687 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5688 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5689 ordinary memory reads.
5690 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5691 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5692 check for successful programming.
5693 @end deffn
5694
5695 @section Other Flash commands
5696 @cindex flash protection
5697
5698 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5699 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5700 and display that status.
5701 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5702 @end deffn
5703
5704 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5705 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5706 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5707
5708 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5709 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5710 and possibly stale information.
5711 @end deffn
5712
5713 @anchor{flashprotect}
5714 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5715 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5716 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5717 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5718 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5719 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5720 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5721 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5722 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5723 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5724 @end deffn
5725
5726 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5727 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5728 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5729 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5730 @end deffn
5731
5732 @anchor{program}
5733 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5734 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5735 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5736 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5737 @end deffn
5738
5739 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5740 @section Flash Driver List
5741 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5742 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5743 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5744
5745 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5746 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5747 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5748
5749 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5750
5751 @itemize
5752 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5753 @end itemize
5754
5755 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5756 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5757 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5758 @example
5759 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5760 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5761 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5762 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5763 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5764 @end example
5765 @end deffn
5766
5767 @subsection External Flash
5768
5769 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5770 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5771 @cindex CFI
5772 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5773 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5774 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5775 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5776 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5777 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5778 configure a bus and its timings), or
5779 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5780 on the flash chip.
5781 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5782 speed up operation.
5783
5784 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5785
5786 @itemize
5787 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5788 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5789 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5790 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5791 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5792 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5793 @end itemize
5794
5795 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5796 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5797
5798 @example
5799 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5800 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5801 @end example
5802
5803 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5804 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5805 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5806
5807 @example
5808 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5809 @end example
5810
5811 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5812 @end deffn
5813
5814 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5815 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5816 @cindex SPI
5817 @cindex jtagspi
5818 @cindex bscan_spi
5819 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5820 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5821 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5822 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5823 accessed through JTAG.
5824
5825 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5826 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5827 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5828 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5829 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5830 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5831
5832 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5833 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5834 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5835 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5836 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5837 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5838 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5839 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5840
5841 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5842 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5843 command, see below.
5844
5845 @itemize
5846 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5847 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5848 @var{USER1} instruction.
5849 @end itemize
5850
5851 @example
5852 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5853 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5854 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5855 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5856 @end example
5857
5858 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5859 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5860 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5861 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5862 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5863 @example
5864 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5865 @end example
5866 @end deffn
5867
5868 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5869 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5870 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5871 @example
5872 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5873 @end example
5874 @end deffn
5875
5876 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5877 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5878 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5879 @end deffn
5880 @end deffn
5881
5882 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5883 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5884 @cindex xcf
5885 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5886 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5887 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5888 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5889 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5890
5891 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5892 command accepts additional parameters:
5893 @itemize
5894 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5895 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5896 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5897 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5898 in master mode.
5899 @end itemize
5900 @example
5901 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5902 @end example
5903 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5904 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5905 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5906 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5907 dedicated sector.
5908 @end deffn
5909
5910 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5911 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5912 button.
5913 @example
5914 xcf configure 0
5915 @end example
5916 @end deffn
5917
5918 Additional driver notes:
5919 @itemize
5920 @item Only single revision supported.
5921 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5922 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5923 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5924 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5925 @end itemize
5926 @end deffn
5927
5928 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5929 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5930 @cindex SPIFI
5931 @cindex lpcspifi
5932 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5933 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5934 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5935
5936 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5937 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5938 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5939 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5940 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5941
5942 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5943 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5944 are configured by the driver.
5945
5946 @example
5947 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5948 @end example
5949
5950 @end deffn
5951
5952 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5953 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5954 @cindex SMI
5955 @cindex stmsmi
5956 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5957 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5958 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5959 SPI flash devices.
5960 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5961 flash devices can be connected.
5962
5963 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5964 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5965 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5966 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5967 the flash content.
5968
5969 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5970 to identify the memory bank.
5971 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5972 flash size, are detected automatically.
5973
5974 @example
5975 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5976 @end example
5977
5978 @end deffn
5979
5980 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5981 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5982 @cindex QuadSPI
5983 @cindex OctoSPI
5984 @cindex stmqspi
5985 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5986 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5987 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5988 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5989 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5990 mode is not.
5991
5992 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5993 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5994 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5995 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5996
5997 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5998 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5999 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
6000
6001 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
6002 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
6003 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
6004 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
6005 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
6006 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
6007
6008 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
6009 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
6010 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
6011 should be avoided.
6012
6013 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
6014 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
6015 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
6016 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
6017 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
6018 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
6019
6020 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
6021 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
6022 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
6023 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
6024 persist across openocd invocations.
6025
6026 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
6027 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
6028 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
6029 required (see 'set' command).
6030
6031 @example
6032 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
6033 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
6034 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
6035 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
6036 @end example
6037
6038 There are three specific commands
6039 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
6040 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
6041 chip specific write protection engaged.
6042 @end deffn
6043
6044 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
6045 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
6046 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
6047 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
6048 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
6049 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
6050
6051 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
6052 which don't support an id command.
6053
6054 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
6055 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
6056 @end deffn
6057
6058 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
6059 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
6060 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
6061 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
6062 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
6063
6064 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
6065 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
6066 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
6067 @var{resp_num} must be even.
6068
6069 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
6070
6071 To check basic communication settings, issue
6072 @example
6073 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6074 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
6075 @end example
6076 for single flash mode or
6077 @example
6078 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6079 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
6080 @end example
6081 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
6082
6083 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
6084 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
6085 need a dummy address, e.g.
6086 @example
6087 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
6088 @end example
6089 should return the status register contents.
6090
6091 @end deffn
6092
6093 @end deffn
6094
6095 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
6096 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
6097 Microcontroller platform.
6098
6099 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
6100 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
6101
6102 @example
6103 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
6104 @end example
6105
6106 @end deffn
6107
6108 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
6109 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
6110 @cindex ath79
6111 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
6112 chip selects.
6113 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
6114 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
6115 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
6116 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
6117 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
6118 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
6119
6120 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
6121 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
6122 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
6123 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
6124 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
6125 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
6126 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
6127 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
6128 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
6129 with the default CS0.
6130 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
6131 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
6132 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
6133
6134 @example
6135 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6136
6137 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
6138 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
6139 # distinguish the banks.
6140 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
6141 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
6142 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
6143 @end example
6144
6145 @end deffn
6146
6147 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
6148 @cindex Freedom E SPI
6149 @cindex fespi
6150
6151 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
6152
6153 @example
6154 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6155 @end example
6156 @end deffn
6157
6158 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
6159
6160 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
6161 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
6162 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6163 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
6164 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
6165 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
6166
6167 @example
6168 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6169 @end example
6170 @end deffn
6171
6172 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
6173 @cindex ambiqmicro
6174 @cindex apollo
6175 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
6176 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6177 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
6178 with the target using SWD.
6179
6180 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
6181 the device class of the MCU.
6182 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
6183 to set up the flash banks.
6184 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
6185 sizes of an Apollo chip.
6186
6187 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
6188 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
6189 and the second bank starts after the first.
6190
6191 @example
6192 # Flash bank 0
6193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6194 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
6195 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
6196 $_TARGETNAME
6197 @end example
6198
6199 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
6200 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
6201 are available to the user.
6202
6203 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
6204
6205 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
6206 Erase entire bank.
6207 @end deffn
6208 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
6209 Erase device pages.
6210 @end deffn
6211 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
6212 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
6213 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
6214 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
6215 the flash.
6216 @end deffn
6217 @end deffn
6218
6219 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
6220 @cindex at91samd
6221 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
6222 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
6223
6224 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6225
6226 The devices have one flash bank:
6227
6228 @example
6229 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6230 @end example
6231
6232 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6233 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6234 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6235 processor to be halted.
6236 @end deffn
6237
6238 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6239 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6240 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6241 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6242 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6243 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6244
6245 @example
6246 at91samd set-security enable
6247 @end example
6248 @end deffn
6249
6250 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6251 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6252 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6253 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6254 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6255 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6256 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6257 in order to disable this feature.
6258
6259 @example
6260 at91samd eeprom
6261 at91samd eeprom 1024
6262 @end example
6263 @end deffn
6264
6265 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6266 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6267 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6268 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6269 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6270 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6271
6272 @example
6273 at91samd bootloader
6274 at91samd bootloader 16384
6275 @end example
6276 @end deffn
6277
6278 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6279 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6280 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6281 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6282 @end deffn
6283
6284 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6285 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6286 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6287 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6288 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6289 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6290 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6291 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6292
6293 @example
6294 # Read user row
6295 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6296 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6297 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6298 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6299 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6300 # byte unchanged
6301 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6302 @end example
6303 @end deffn
6304
6305 @end deffn
6306
6307 @anchor{at91sam3}
6308 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6309 @cindex at91sam3
6310 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6311 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6312 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6313 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6314 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6315 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6316 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6317 chips are confirmed.}
6318
6319 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6320 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6321 the following fixed locations:
6322
6323 @example
6324 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6325 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6326 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6327 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6328 @end example
6329
6330 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6331 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6332 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6333
6334 @itemize
6335 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6336 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6337 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6338 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6339 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6340 @end itemize
6341
6342 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6343
6344 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6345 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6346 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6347 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6348 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6349 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6350 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6351
6352 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6353 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6354 @end deffn
6355
6356 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6357 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6358 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6359 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6360 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6361 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6362 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6363 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6364 @end deffn
6365
6366 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6367 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6368 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6369 @end deffn
6370 @end deffn
6371
6372 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6373 @cindex at91sam4
6374 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6375 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6376 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6377 @end deffn
6378
6379 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6380 @cindex at91sam4l
6381 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6382 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6383 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6384
6385 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6386 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6387 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6388 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6389 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6390 @end deffn
6391 @end deffn
6392
6393 @anchor{atsame5}
6394 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6395 @cindex atsame5
6396 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6397 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6398 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6399
6400 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6401 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6402 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6403
6404 @example
6405 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6406 @end example
6407
6408 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6409 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6410 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6411 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6412 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6413 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6414
6415 @example
6416 atsame5 bootloader
6417 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6418 @end example
6419 @end deffn
6420
6421 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6422 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6423 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6424 processor to be halted.
6425 @end deffn
6426
6427 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6428 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6429 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6430 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6431 @end deffn
6432
6433 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6434 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6435 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6436 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6437 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6438 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6439 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6440 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6441
6442 @example
6443 # Read
6444 >atsame5 userpage
6445 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6446 # Write
6447 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6448 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6449 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6450 # bytes)
6451 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6452 @end example
6453 @end deffn
6454
6455 @end deffn
6456
6457 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6458 @cindex atsamv
6459 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6460 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6461 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6462
6463 @example
6464 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6465 @end example
6466
6467 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6468 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6469 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6470 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6471 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6472
6473 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6474 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6475 @end deffn
6476
6477 @end deffn
6478
6479 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6480 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6481 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6482 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6483 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6484
6485 @example
6486 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6487 @end example
6488
6489 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6490 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6491
6492 @itemize
6493 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6494 @item @var{banks}
6495 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6496 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6497 @item @var{pages_size}
6498 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6499 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6500 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6501 @end itemize
6502
6503 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6504 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6505 will be autoconfigured.
6506 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6507
6508 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6509 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6510 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6511 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6512 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6513
6514 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6515 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6516 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6517 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6518 are not truly general purpose).
6519 @quotation Note
6520 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6521 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6522 @end quotation
6523 @end deffn
6524 @end deffn
6525
6526 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6527 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6528 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6529 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6530 @end deffn
6531
6532 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6533 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP/LPS Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6534 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6535 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6536
6537 @example
6538 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6539 @end example
6540
6541 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6542 each single sector one by one.
6543
6544 @example
6545 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6546 @end example
6547
6548 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6549 @end deffn
6550
6551 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6552 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6553 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6554 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6555 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6556 starts at address 0.
6557
6558 @example
6559 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6560 @end example
6561 @end deffn
6562
6563 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6564 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6565 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6566 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6567 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6568 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6569 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6570 and programming the serial flash.
6571
6572 @example
6573 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6574 @end example
6575 @end deffn
6576
6577 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6578 All members of the EFM32/EFR32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro (now Silicon Labs)
6579 include internal flash and use Arm Cortex-M3 or Cortex-M4 cores. The driver automatically
6580 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6581 autoconfigures itself.
6582 @example
6583 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6584 @end example
6585 It supports writing to the user data page, as well as the portion of the lockbits page
6586 past 512 bytes on chips with larger page sizes. The latter is used by the SiLabs
6587 bootloader/AppLoader system for encryption keys. Setting protection on these pages is
6588 currently not supported.
6589 @example
6590 flash bank userdata.flash efm32 0x0FE00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6591 flash bank lockbits.flash efm32 0x0FE04000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6592 @end example
6593
6594 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6595 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6596 this via the following command:
6597 @example
6598 efm32 debuglock num
6599 @end example
6600 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6601 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6602 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6603 supported.}
6604 @end deffn
6605
6606 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6607 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6608 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6609 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6610 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6611 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6612
6613 @example
6614 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6615 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6616 @end example
6617
6618 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6619 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6620 @end deffn
6621
6622 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6623 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6624 is an uncommon operation.}
6625 @end deffn
6626 @end deffn
6627
6628 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6629 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6630 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6631 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6632 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6633 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6634 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6635
6636 @example
6637 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6638 @end example
6639 @end deffn
6640
6641 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6642 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6643 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6644 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6645 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6646 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6647 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6648 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6649 characters) ignored.
6650
6651 @example
6652 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6653 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6654 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6655 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6656 @end example
6657 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6658 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6659 @end deffn
6660
6661 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6662 @cindex kinetis
6663 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6664 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6665 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6666 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6667 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6668 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6669
6670 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6671 @itemize
6672 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6673 @end itemize
6674
6675 @example
6676 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6677 @end example
6678
6679 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6680 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6681 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6682 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6683 @end deffn
6684
6685 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6686 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6687 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6688 set by 'flash protect' command.
6689 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6690 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6691 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6692 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6693 with the rest of a flash image.
6694 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6695 @end deffn
6696
6697 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6698 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6699 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6703 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6704 and examine-fail event.
6705 @end deffn
6706
6707 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6708 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6709 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6710 @end deffn
6711
6712 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6713 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6714 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6715 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6716 command completes.
6717 @end deffn
6718
6719 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6720 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6721 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6722 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6723 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6724
6725 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6726 Program Partition command.
6727
6728 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6729 Reset the device after partition setting.
6730
6731 Show partition size:
6732 @example
6733 kinetis nvm_partition info
6734 @end example
6735
6736 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6737 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6738 @example
6739 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6740 @end example
6741
6742 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6743 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6744 @example
6745 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6746 @end example
6747 @end deffn
6748
6749 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6750 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6751 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6752 @end deffn
6753
6754 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6755 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6756 Command disables watchdog timer.
6757 @end deffn
6758 @end deffn
6759
6760 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6761 @cindex kinetis_ke
6762 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6763 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6764 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6765 autoconfigures itself.
6766 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6767
6768 @example
6769 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6770 @end example
6771
6772 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6773 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6774 @end deffn
6775
6776 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6777 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6778 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6779 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6780 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6784 Command disables watchdog timer.
6785 @end deffn
6786 @end deffn
6787
6788 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6789 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6790 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6791 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6792 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6793
6794 @quotation Note
6795 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6796 driver:
6797 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6798 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6799 @end quotation
6800
6801 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6802 which must appear in the following order:
6803
6804 @itemize
6805 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6806 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6807 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6808 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6809 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6810 LPC43x[2357])
6811 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6812 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6813 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6814 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6815 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6816 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6817 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6818 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6819 at which the core is running
6820 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6821 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6822 @quotation Note
6823 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6824 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6825 However, if you do provide it,
6826 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6827 @end quotation
6828 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6829 ROM IAP entry point.
6830 @end itemize
6831
6832 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6833
6834 @example
6835 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6836 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6837 @end example
6838
6839 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6840 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6841 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6842 @end deffn
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6846 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6847 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6848 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6849 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6850 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6851
6852 @example
6853 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6854 @end example
6855 @end deffn
6856
6857 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6858 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6859 from NXP.
6860
6861 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6862 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6863 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6864 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6865 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6866 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6867 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6868 you start the PLL.
6869
6870 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6871
6872 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6873 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6874 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6875
6876 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6877 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6878 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6879 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6880 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6881 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6882 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6883
6884 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6885 @example
6886 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6887 @end example
6888
6889 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6890 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6891 @code{flash banks} command.
6892
6893 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6894 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6895 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6896 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6897 a known signature.
6898 Example:
6899 @example
6900 lpc2900 signature 0
6901 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6902 @end example
6903 @end deffn
6904
6905 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6906 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6907 saves it to a file in binary format.
6908 Example:
6909 @example
6910 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6911 @end example
6912 @end deffn
6913
6914 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6915 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6916 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6917 command:
6918
6919 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6920 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6921 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6922 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6923
6924 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6925 Example:
6926 @example
6927 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6928 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6929 @end example
6930 @end deffn
6931
6932 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6933 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6934 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6935 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6936 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6937 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6938 912 bytes.
6939 @quotation Attention
6940 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6941 @end quotation
6942 Example:
6943 @example
6944 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6945 @end example
6946 @end deffn
6947
6948 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6949 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6950 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6951 after the next power cycle.
6952 @quotation Attention
6953 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6954 @end quotation
6955 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6956 Example:
6957 @example
6958 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6959 flash info 0
6960 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6961 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6962 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6963 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6964 @end example
6965 @end deffn
6966
6967 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6968 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6969 effective after the next power cycle.
6970 @quotation Attention
6971 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6972 @end quotation
6973 Examples:
6974 @example
6975 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6976 @end example
6977 @end deffn
6978 @end deffn
6979
6980 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6981 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6982 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6983 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6984
6985 @example
6986 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6987 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6988 @end example
6989
6990 @itemize @bullet
6991 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6992 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6993 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6994 @end itemize
6995
6996 Example usage:
6997 @example
6998 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6999 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
7000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
7001 @} else @{
7002 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
7003 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
7004 @}
7005 @end example
7006 @end deffn
7007
7008 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
7009 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
7010 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
7011 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
7012 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
7013 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
7014
7015 @example
7016 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7017 @end example
7018
7019 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
7020 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
7021 only the main program flash.
7022
7023 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
7024 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
7025 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
7026 @end deffn
7027
7028 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
7029 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
7030 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
7031 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
7032
7033 To erase and program the BSL:
7034 @example
7035 msp432 bsl unlock
7036 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
7037 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
7038 msp432 bsl lock
7039 @end example
7040 @end deffn
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
7044 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
7045 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
7046 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
7047 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
7048 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
7049 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
7050 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
7051 also have division into regions: main and info.
7052 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
7053 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
7054
7055 @example
7056 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7057 @end example
7058
7059 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
7060
7061 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
7062 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
7063 @end deffn
7064
7065 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
7066 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
7070 Erase all userflash including info region.
7071 @end deffn
7072
7073 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
7074 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7075 @end deffn
7076
7077 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
7078 Check sectors protect.
7079 @end deffn
7080
7081 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
7082 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
7083 @end deffn
7084
7085 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
7086 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
7087 @end deffn
7088
7089 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
7090 Configure external memory interface for boot.
7091 @end deffn
7092
7093 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
7094 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
7095 @end deffn
7096
7097 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
7098 Show information about flash driver.
7099 @end deffn
7100
7101 @end deffn
7102
7103 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
7104 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
7105 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
7106 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
7107 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
7108
7109 @example
7110 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7111 @end example
7112 @end deffn
7113
7114 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
7115 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
7116 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
7117 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
7118 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
7119 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
7120 - ACL).
7121
7122 @example
7123 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7124 @end example
7125
7126 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
7127
7128 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
7129 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
7130 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
7131 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
7132 code.
7133 @end deffn
7134
7135 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
7136 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
7137 @end deffn
7138
7139 @end deffn
7140
7141 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
7142 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
7143 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
7144
7145 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
7146 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
7147 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
7148 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
7149
7150 @example
7151 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7152 @end example
7153 @end deffn
7154
7155 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
7156 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
7157 and integrate flash memory.
7158
7159 @example
7160 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7161 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7162 @end example
7163
7164 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
7165 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
7166 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
7167 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
7168 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
7169 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
7170 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
7171 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
7172 @end deffn
7173 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
7174 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
7175 This will remove any Code Protection.
7176 @end deffn
7177 @end deffn
7178
7179 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
7180 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
7181 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
7182 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7183 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7184
7185 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
7186 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
7187
7188 @example
7189 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7190 @end example
7191
7192 psoc4-specific commands
7193 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
7194 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
7195
7196 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
7197 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
7198
7199 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
7200 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
7201 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
7202
7203 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7204 @end deffn
7205
7206 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
7207 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
7208
7209 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7210 @end deffn
7211 @end deffn
7212
7213 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
7214 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7215 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7216 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7217 apart from the base address.
7218
7219 @example
7220 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7221 @end example
7222
7223 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
7224 @quotation Attention
7225 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
7226 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
7227 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
7228 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
7229 @end quotation
7230
7231 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
7232
7233 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7234 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7235 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7236 @end deffn
7237 @end deffn
7238
7239 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7240 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7241 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7242 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7243 apart from the base address.
7244
7245 @example
7246 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7247 $_TARGETNAME
7248 @end example
7249 @end deffn
7250
7251 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7252 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7253 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7254 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7255
7256 @example
7257 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7258 @end example
7259
7260 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7261
7262 @itemize
7263 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7264 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7265 @end itemize
7266
7267 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7268
7269 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7270 @quotation Attention
7271 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7272 after successful write.
7273 @end quotation
7274 @end deffn
7275
7276 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7277 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7278 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7279 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7280
7281 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7282 @itemize @bullet
7283 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7284 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7285 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7286 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7287 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7288 row size: 512 bytes.
7289 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7290 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7291 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7292 operation will erase row automatically.
7293 @end itemize
7294
7295 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7296 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7297
7298 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7299
7300 @example
7301 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7302 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7303 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7304 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7305 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7306 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7307 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7308 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7309 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7310 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7311 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7312 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7313
7314 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7315 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7316 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7317 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7318 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7319 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7320 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7321 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7322 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7323 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7324 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7325 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7326 @end example
7327
7328 psoc6-specific commands
7329 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7330 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7331 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7332 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7333 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7334 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7335 @end deffn
7336
7337 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7338 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7339 by @command{flash banks}.
7340 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7341 @end deffn
7342 @end deffn
7343
7344 @deffn {Flash Driver} {qn908x}
7345 The NXP QN908x microcontrollers feature a Cortex-M4F with integrated Bluetooth
7346 LE 5 support and an internal flash of up to 512 KiB. These chips only support
7347 the SWD interface.
7348
7349 The @var{qn908x} driver uses the internal "Flash Memory Controller" block via
7350 SWD to erase, program and read the internal flash. This driver does not
7351 support the ISP (In-System Programming) mode which is an alternate way to
7352 program the flash via UART, SPI or USB.
7353
7354 The internal flash is 512 KiB in size in all released chips and it starts at
7355 the address 0x01000000, although it can be mapped to address 0 and it is
7356 aliased to other addresses. This driver only recognizes the bank starting at
7357 address 0x01000000.
7358
7359 The internal bootloader stored in ROM is in charge of loading and verifying
7360 the image from flash, or enter ISP mode. The programmed image must start at
7361 the beginning of the flash and contain a valid header and a matching CRC32
7362 checksum. Additionally, the image header contains a "Code Read Protection"
7363 (CRP) word which indicates whether SWD access is enabled, as well as whether
7364 ISP mode is enabled. Therefore, it is possible to program an image that
7365 disables SWD and ISP making it impossible to program another image in the
7366 future through these interfaces, or even debug the current image. While this is
7367 a valid use case for production deployments where the chips are locked down, by
7368 default this driver doesn't allow such images that disable the SWD interface.
7369 To program such images see the @command{qn908x allow_brick} command.
7370
7371 Apart from the CRP field which is located in the image header, the last page
7372 of the flash memory contains a "Flash lock and protect" descriptor which allows
7373 to individually protect each 2 KiB page, as well as disabling SWD access to the
7374 flash and RAM. If this access is disabled it is not possible to read, erase or
7375 program individual pages from the SWD interface or even access the read-only
7376 "Flash information page" with information about the bootloader version and
7377 flash size. However when this protection is in place, it is still possible to
7378 mass erase the whole chip and then program a new image, for which you can use
7379 the @command{qn908x mass_erase}.
7380
7381 Example:
7382 @example
7383 flash bank $FLASHNAME qn908x 0x01000000 0 0 0 $TARGETNAME calc_checksum
7384 @end example
7385
7386 Parameters:
7387 @itemize
7388 @item @option{calc_checksum} optional parameter to compute the required
7389 checksum of the first bytes in the vector table.
7390 @quotation Note
7391 If the checksum in the header of your image is invalid and you don't provide the
7392 @option{calc_checksum} option the boot ROM will not boot your image and it may
7393 render the flash inaccessible. On the other hand, if you use this option to
7394 compute the checksum keep in mind that @command{verify_image} will fail on
7395 those four bytes of the checksum since those bytes in the flash will have the
7396 updated checksum.
7397 @end quotation
7398 @end itemize
7399
7400 @deffn {Command} {qn908x allow_brick}
7401 Allow the qn908x driver to program images with a "Code Read Protection" byte
7402 that disables the SWD access. Programming such image will cause OpenOCD to
7403 not be able to reach the target over SWD anymore after the new image is
7404 programmed and its configuration takes effect, e.g. after a reboot. After
7405 executing @command{qn908x allow_brick} these images will be allowed to be
7406 programmed when writing to the flash.
7407 @end deffn
7408
7409 @deffn {Command} {qn908x disable_wdog}
7410 Disable the watchdog timer (WDT) by resetting its CTRL field. The WDT starts
7411 enabled after a @command{reset halt} and it doesn't run while the target is
7412 halted. However, the verification process in this driver uses the generic
7413 Cortex-M verification process which executes a payload in RAM and thus
7414 requires the watchdog to be disabled before running @command{verify_image}
7415 after a reset halt or any other condition where the watchdog is running.
7416 Note that this is not done automatically and you must run this command in
7417 those scenarios.
7418 @end deffn
7419
7420 @deffn {Command} {qn908x mass_erase}
7421 Erases the complete flash using the mass_erase method. Mass erase is only
7422 allowed if enabled in the Lock Status Register 8 (LOCK_STAT_8) which is read
7423 from the last sector of the flash on boot. However, this mass_erase lock
7424 protection can be bypassed and this command does so automatically.
7425
7426 In the same LOCK_STAT_8 the flash and RAM access from SWD can be disabled by
7427 setting two bits in this register. After a mass_erase, all the bits of the
7428 flash would be set, making it the default to restrict SWD access to the flash
7429 and RAM regions. This new after erase LOCK_STAT_8 value only takes effect after
7430 being read from flash on the next reboot for example. After a mass_erase the
7431 LOCK_STAT_8 register is changed by the hardware to allow access to flash and
7432 RAM regardless of the value on flash, but only right after a mass_erase and
7433 until the next boot. Therefore it is possible to perform a mass_erase, program
7434 a new image, verify it and then reboot to a valid image that's locked from the
7435 SWD access.
7436
7437 The @command{qn908x mass_erase} command clears the bits that would be loaded
7438 from the flash into LOCK_STAT_8 after erasing the whole chip to allow SWD
7439 access for debugging or re-flashing an image without a mass_erase by default.
7440 If the image being programmed also programs the last page of the flash with its
7441 own settings, this mass_erase behavior will interfere with that write since a
7442 new erase of at least the last page would need to be performed before writing
7443 to it again. For this reason the optional @option{keep_lock} argument can be
7444 used to leave the flash and RAM lock set. For development environments, the
7445 default behavior is desired.
7446
7447 The mass erase locking mechanism is independent from the individual page
7448 locking bits, so it is possible that you can't erase a given page that is
7449 locked and you can't unprotect that page because the locking bits are also
7450 locked, but can still mass erase the whole flash.
7451 @end deffn
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7455 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7456 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7457 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7458 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7459
7460 @example
7461 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7462 @end example
7463 @end deffn
7464
7465 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rsl10}
7466 Supports Onsemi RSL10 microcontroller flash memory. Uses functions
7467 stored in ROM to control flash memory interface.
7468
7469 @example
7470 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rsl10 $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7471 @end example
7472
7473 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 lock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7474 Writes @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to @var{0x81044 0x81048 0x8104c
7475 0x8050}. Locks debug port by writing @var{0x4C6F634B} to @var{0x81040}.
7476
7477 To unlock use the @command{rsl10 unlock key1 key2 key3 key4} command.
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 unlock} key1 key2 key3 key4
7481 Unlocks debug port, by writing @var{key1 key2 key3 key4} words to
7482 registers through DAP, and clears @var{0x81040} address in flash to 0x1.
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @deffn {Command} {rsl10 mass_erase}
7486 Erases all unprotected flash sectors.
7487 @end deffn
7488 @end deffn
7489
7490 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7491 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7492 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7493 and SWD interface.
7494 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7495 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7496
7497 @example
7498 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7499 @end example
7500
7501 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7502
7503 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7504 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7505 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7506 @end deffn
7507
7508 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7509 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7510 @end deffn
7511 @end deffn
7512
7513 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7514 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7515 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7516 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7517 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7518
7519 @example
7520 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7521 @end example
7522
7523 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7524 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7525 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7526 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7527 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7528 disabled.
7529
7530 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7531 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7532 @quotation Warning
7533 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7534 applied to all of them.
7535 @end quotation
7536 @end deffn
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7540 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7541 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7542 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7543 The driver also works with GD32VF103 powered by RISC-V core.
7544 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7545 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7546
7547 @example
7548 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7549 @end example
7550
7551 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7552 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7553 the flash driver.
7554
7555 @example
7556 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7557 @end example
7558
7559 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7560 as per the following example.
7561 @example
7562 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7563 @end example
7564
7565 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7566
7567 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7568 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7569 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7570 @end deffn
7571
7572 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7573 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7574 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7575 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7576 @end deffn
7577
7578 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7579 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7580 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7581 @end deffn
7582
7583 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7584 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7585 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7586 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7587 @end deffn
7588
7589 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7590 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7591 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7592 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7593 @end deffn
7594
7595 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7596 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7597 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7598 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7599 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7600 @end deffn
7601 @end deffn
7602
7603 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7604 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7605 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7606 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7607 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7608
7609 @example
7610 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7611 @end example
7612
7613 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7614 as per the following example.
7615 @example
7616 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7617 @end example
7618
7619 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7620 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7621 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7622 @end deffn
7623
7624 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7625 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7626 the flash driver.
7627
7628 @example
7629 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7630 @end example
7631
7632 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7633
7634 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7635 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7636 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7637 @end deffn
7638
7639 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7640 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7641 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7642 @end deffn
7643
7644 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7645 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7646 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7647 @end deffn
7648
7649 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7650 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7651 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7652 @end deffn
7653
7654 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7655 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7656 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7657 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7658 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7659 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7660 @end deffn
7661
7662 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7663 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7664 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7665 @end deffn
7666 @end deffn
7667
7668 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7669 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7670 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7671 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7672 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7673
7674 @example
7675 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7676 @end example
7677
7678 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7679 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7680 the flash driver.
7681
7682 @example
7683 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7684 @end example
7685
7686 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7687
7688 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7689 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7690 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7691 @end deffn
7692
7693 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7694 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7695 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7696 @end deffn
7697
7698 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7699 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7700 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7701 @end deffn
7702
7703 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7704 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7705 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7706 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7707 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7708
7709 Example usage:
7710 @example
7711 # read OPTSR_CUR
7712 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7713 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7714 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7715 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7716 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7717 @end example
7718 @end deffn
7719
7720 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7721 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7722 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7723 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7724 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7725 will be touched).
7726
7727 Example usage:
7728 @example
7729 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7730 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7731 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7732 @end example
7733 @end deffn
7734 @end deffn
7735
7736 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7737 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7738 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7739 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7740 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7741
7742 @example
7743 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7744 @end example
7745
7746 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7747 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7748 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7749 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7750 second bank.
7751
7752 @example
7753 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7754 @end example
7755
7756 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7757
7758 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7759 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7760 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7761 @end deffn
7762
7763 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7764 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7765 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7766 @end deffn
7767
7768 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7769 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7770 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7771 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7772 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7773 @end deffn
7774 @end deffn
7775
7776 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7777 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7778 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7779 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7780 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7781 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7782
7783 @example
7784 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7785 @end example
7786
7787 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7788 as per the following example.
7789 @example
7790 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7791 @end example
7792
7793 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7794 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7795 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7796 @end deffn
7797
7798 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7799 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7800 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7801 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7802
7803 @example
7804 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7805 @end example
7806
7807 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7808
7809 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7810 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7811 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7812
7813 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7814 @end deffn
7815
7816 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7817 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7818 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7819
7820 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7821 @end deffn
7822
7823 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7824 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7825 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7826 @end deffn
7827
7828 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7829 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7830 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7831 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7832
7833 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7834 @example
7835 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7836 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7837 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7838 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7839 @end example
7840
7841 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7842 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7843 @end deffn
7844
7845 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7846 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7847 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7848 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7849 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7850
7851 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7852
7853 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7854 @example
7855 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7856 @end example
7857
7858 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7859 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7860 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7861 @end deffn
7862
7863 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7864 List the protected areas using WRP.
7865 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7866 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7867 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7868
7869 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7870 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7871 in single or dual-banks mode.
7872 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7873 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7874
7875 @end deffn
7876
7877 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7878 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7879 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7880 @end deffn
7881
7882 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7883 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7884 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7885 the TrustZone status.
7886 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7887 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7888 @end deffn
7889 @end deffn
7890
7891 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7892 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7893 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7894 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7895 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7896
7897 @example
7898 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7899 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7900 @end example
7901
7902 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7903 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7904 for the specified flash bank.
7905 @end deffn
7906 @end deffn
7907
7908 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7909 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7910 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7911 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7912 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7913
7914 @example
7915 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7916 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7917 @end example
7918
7919 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7920 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7921 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7922
7923 @itemize @bullet
7924 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7925 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7926 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7927 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7928 @end itemize
7929 @end deffn
7930
7931 @end deffn
7932
7933 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7934 @cindex str9xpec
7935
7936 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7937 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7938 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7939 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7940
7941 Here is some background info to help
7942 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7943 the str9:
7944 @enumerate
7945 @item
7946 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7947 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7948 @item
7949 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7950 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7951 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7952 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7953 @end enumerate
7954
7955 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7956 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7957 configured for flash bank 0.
7958 @example
7959 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7960 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7961 adapter assert srst
7962 # turn off target polling
7963 poll off
7964 # disable str9 core
7965 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7966 # read option bytes
7967 str9xpec options_read 0
7968 # re-enable str9 core
7969 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7970 poll on
7971 reset halt
7972 @end example
7973 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7974 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7975 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7976 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7977
7978 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7979
7980 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7981 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7982 @end deffn
7983
7984 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7985 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7986 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7987 @end deffn
7988
7989 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7990 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7991 erase the device.
7992 @end deffn
7993
7994 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7995 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7999 Configure str9 boot bank.
8000 @end deffn
8001
8002 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
8003 Configure str9 lvd source.
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
8007 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
8008 @end deffn
8009
8010 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
8011 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
8012 @end deffn
8013
8014 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
8015 Read str9 option bytes.
8016 @end deffn
8017
8018 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
8019 Write str9 option bytes.
8020 @end deffn
8021
8022 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
8023 unlock str9 device.
8024 @end deffn
8025
8026 @end deffn
8027
8028 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
8029 @cindex swm050
8030 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
8031
8032 @example
8033 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
8034 @end example
8035
8036 One swm050-specific command is defined:
8037
8038 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
8039 Erases the entire flash bank.
8040 @end deffn
8041
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044
8045 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
8046 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
8047 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
8048 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8049
8050 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
8051
8052 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
8053 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
8054 @end deffn
8055
8056 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
8057 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
8058 @end deffn
8059
8060 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
8061 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
8062 the flash clock.
8063 @end deffn
8064 @end deffn
8065
8066 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
8067 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
8068 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
8069 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
8070 correct bank config.
8071
8072 @example
8073 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
8074 @end example
8075 @end deffn
8076
8077 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
8078 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8079 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8080 @end deffn
8081
8082 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
8083 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
8084 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
8085
8086 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
8087
8088 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
8089 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
8090 @end deffn
8091
8092 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
8093 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
8094 @end deffn
8095
8096 @end deffn
8097
8098 @section NAND Flash Commands
8099 @cindex NAND
8100
8101 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
8102 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
8103 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
8104
8105 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
8106 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
8107 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
8108 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
8109 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
8110 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
8111
8112 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
8113 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
8114 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
8115 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
8116 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
8117 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
8118 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
8119 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
8120 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
8121 with techniques such as wear leveling.
8122
8123 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
8124 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
8125 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
8126 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
8127 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
8128 every 512 bytes of data.
8129
8130 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
8131 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
8132 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
8133 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
8134 ECC mode is used.
8135
8136 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
8137 @enumerate
8138 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
8139 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
8140 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
8141 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
8142 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
8143 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
8144 to access that device.
8145 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
8146 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
8147 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
8148 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
8149 de-brick a board.
8150 @end enumerate
8151
8152 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
8153 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
8154 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
8155 are only 32 bits wide.
8156 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
8157 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
8158 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
8159 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
8160
8161 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
8162 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
8163 @cindex NAND configuration
8164
8165 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
8166 plus some additional configuration that's done after
8167 OpenOCD has initialized.
8168
8169 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
8170 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
8171 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
8172 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
8173 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
8174 they were a single (larger) device.
8175 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
8176 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
8177
8178 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
8179 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
8180 configuration files, not interactively.
8181
8182 @itemize @bullet
8183 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
8184 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
8185 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
8186 associated with the NAND device being declared.
8187 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
8188 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
8189 commands to the NAND controller.
8190 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
8191 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
8192 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
8193 for more information.
8194 @end itemize
8195 @end deffn
8196
8197 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
8198 Prints a summary of each device declared
8199 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
8200 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
8201 @example
8202 > nand list
8203 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8204 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8205 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
8206 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
8207 >
8208 @end example
8209 @end deffn
8210
8211 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
8212 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
8213 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
8214 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8215 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
8216 it with most other NAND commands.
8217 @end deffn
8218
8219 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
8220
8221 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
8222 @cindex NAND reading
8223 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
8224 starting at the specified offset.
8225 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8226
8227 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8228 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8229
8230 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
8231 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
8232 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
8233
8234 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
8235 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
8236 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
8237 method which handled that error correction.
8238
8239 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
8240 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
8241 @itemize @bullet
8242 @item no oob_* parameter
8243 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
8244 @item @code{oob_raw}
8245 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
8246 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
8247 spare areas associated with each data page.
8248 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
8249 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
8250 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
8251 @item @code{oob_only}
8252 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
8253 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
8254 spare areas associated with each data page.
8255 @end itemize
8256 @end deffn
8257
8258 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
8259 @cindex NAND erasing
8260 @cindex NAND programming
8261 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
8262 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
8263 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8264 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8265 If those parameters are not specified,
8266 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
8267 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8268
8269 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
8270 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
8271 block marker.
8272 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
8273 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
8274 @end deffn
8275
8276 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
8277 @cindex NAND writing
8278 @cindex NAND programming
8279 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
8280 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
8281 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
8282 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8283
8284 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8285 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8286
8287 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8288 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
8289 past the end of the device.
8290 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
8291 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
8292 if that's being written.)
8293
8294 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
8295 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
8296 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
8297
8298 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
8299 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
8300 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
8301 @itemize @bullet
8302 @item no oob_* parameter
8303 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8304 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
8305 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8306 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
8307 with hardware-computed ECC data.
8308 @item @code{oob_only}
8309 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
8310 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
8311 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
8312 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
8313 @item @code{oob_raw}
8314 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
8315 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
8316 un-altered OOB.
8317 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
8318 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
8319 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
8320 @item @code{oob_softecc}
8321 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8322 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
8323 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
8324 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8325 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8326 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
8327 @*File has only page data, which is written.
8328 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
8329 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
8330 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
8331 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
8332 @end itemize
8333 @end deffn
8334
8335 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
8336 @cindex NAND verification
8337 @cindex NAND programming
8338 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
8339 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
8340 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8341
8342 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
8343 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
8344
8345 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
8346 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
8347 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
8348 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
8349 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
8350
8351 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
8352 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
8353 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
8354
8355 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
8356 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
8357 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
8358 be removed in a future release.
8359 @end deffn
8360
8361 @subsection Other NAND commands
8362 @cindex NAND other commands
8363
8364 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
8365 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
8366 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
8367 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
8368 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8369 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8370 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8371 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8372
8373 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8374 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8375 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8376 @end deffn
8377
8378 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8379 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8380 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8381 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8382 status for each block.
8383 @end deffn
8384
8385 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8386 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8387 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8388
8389 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8390 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8391 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8392 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8393 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8394
8395 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8396 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8397 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8398 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8399 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8400 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8401 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8402 @end deffn
8403
8404 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8405 @subsection NAND Driver List
8406 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8407 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8408 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8409
8410 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8411 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8412 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8413 address of the ECC controller.
8414 @example
8415 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8416 @end example
8417 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8418 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8419 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8420 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8421 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8422 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8423 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8424 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8425 @end deffn
8426 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8427 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8428 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8429 @end deffn
8430
8431 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8432 properly configured for input or output.
8433 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8434 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8435 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8436 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8437 @end deffn
8438 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8439 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8440 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8441 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8442 @end deffn
8443 @end deffn
8444
8445 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8446 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8447 chips from Texas Instruments.
8448 It takes three extra parameters:
8449 address of the NAND chip;
8450 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8451 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8452 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8453 @example
8454 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8455 @end example
8456 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8457 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8458 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8459 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8460 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8461 @end deffn
8462
8463 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8464 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8465 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8466 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8467 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8468 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8469 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8470 @end deffn
8471
8472 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8473 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8474 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8475 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8476 @end deffn
8477 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8478
8479 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8480 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8481 should work for this chip as well.
8482 @end deffn
8483
8484 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8485 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8486 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8487 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8488 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8489 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8490 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8491 @example
8492 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8493 @end example
8494 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8495 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8496 without parameter query status.
8497 @end deffn
8498 @end deffn
8499
8500 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8501 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8502 parameter: the address of the controller.
8503 @example
8504 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8505 @end example
8506 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8507 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8508 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8509 change any behavior.
8510 @end deffn
8511
8512 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8513 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8514 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8515 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8516 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8517 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8518 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8519 specialized commands.
8520 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8521 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8522 change any behavior.
8523 @end deffn
8524
8525 @node Flash Programming
8526 @chapter Flash Programming
8527
8528 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8529 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8530 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8531
8532 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8533 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8534
8535 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8536 @enumerate
8537 @item 'init' is executed.
8538 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8539 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8540 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8541 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8542 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8543 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8544 @end enumerate
8545
8546 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8547
8548 @example
8549 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8550 # are optional parameters
8551 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8552 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8553
8554 # binary files need the flash address passing
8555 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8556 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8557 @end example
8558
8559 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8560 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8561 @cindex PLD
8562 @cindex FPGA
8563
8564 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8565 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8566 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8567 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8568 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8569 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8570 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8571
8572 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8573
8574 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8575 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8576 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8577
8578 They are referenced by the name which was given when the pld was created or
8579 the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command.
8580 New PLDs are defined by @command{pld create pld_name driver_name -chain-position tap_name [driver_options]}.
8581
8582 @deffn {Config Command} {pld create} pld_name driver_name -chain-position tap_name [driver_options]
8583 Creates a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8584 assigning @var{pld_name} for further reference.
8585 @code{-chain-position} @var{tap_name} names the TAP
8586 used to access this target.
8587 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its behavior.
8588 @end deffn
8589
8590 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8591 List the known PLDs with their name.
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594 @deffn {Command} {pld load} pld_name filename
8595 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{pld_name}.
8596 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8597 @end deffn
8598
8599 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8600
8601 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8602 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8603 that particular type of PLD.
8604
8605 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [@option{-no_jstart}]
8606 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8607 This driver can also be used to load Series3, Series6, Series7 and Zynq 7000 devices.
8608 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8609
8610 If @var{-no_jstart} is given, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8611 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8612 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8613
8614 @example
8615 openocd -f board/digilent_zedboard.cfg -c "init" \
8616 -c "pld load 0 zedboard_bitstream.bit"
8617 @end example
8618
8619
8620 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} pld_name
8621 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8622 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8623 @end deffn
8624
8625 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 set_instr_codes} pld_name cfg_out cfg_in jprogb jstart jshutdown [user1 [user2 [user3 [user4]]]]
8626 Change values for boundary scan instructions. Default are values for Virtex 2, devices Virtex 4/5/6 and
8627 SSI devices are using different values.
8628 @var{pld_name} is the name of the pld device.
8629 @var{cfg_out} is the value used to select CFG_OUT instruction.
8630 @var{cfg_in} is the value used to select CFG_IN instruction.
8631 @var{jprogb} is the value used to select JPROGRAM instruction.
8632 @var{jstart} is the value used to select JSTART instruction.
8633 @var{jshutdown} is the value used to select JSHUTDOWN instruction.
8634 @var{user1} to @var{user4} are the intruction used to select the user registers USER1 to USER4.
8635 @end deffn
8636
8637 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 set_user_codes} pld_name user1 [user2 [user3 [user4]]]
8638 Change values for boundary scan instructions selecting the registers USER1 to USER4.
8639 Description of the arguments can be found at command @command{virtex2 set_instr_codes}.
8640 @end deffn
8641 @end deffn
8642
8643
8644
8645 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {lattice} [@option{-family} <name>]
8646 The FGPA families ECP2, ECP3, ECP5, Certus and CertusPro by Lattice are supported.
8647 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into the FPGA or read the status register and read/write the usercode register.
8648
8649 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{ecp2 ecp3 ecp5 certus}. This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is not known by openocd (newer NX devices).
8650
8651 @deffn {Command} {lattice read_status} pld_name
8652 Reads and displays the status register
8653 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8654 @end deffn
8655
8656 @deffn {Command} {lattice read_user} pld_name
8657 Reads and displays the user register
8658 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn {Command} {lattice write_user} pld_name val
8662 Writes the user register.
8663 for FPGA @var{pld_name} with value @var{val}.
8664 @end deffn
8665
8666 @deffn {Command} {lattice set_preload} pld_name length
8667 Set the length of the register for the preload. This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is not known by openocd (newer NX devices).
8668 The load command for the FPGA @var{pld_name} will use a length for the preload of @var{length}.
8669 @end deffn
8670 @end deffn
8671
8672
8673 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {efinix}
8674 Both families (Trion and Titanium) sold by Efinix are supported as both use the same protocol for In-System Configuration.
8675 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into the FPGA.
8676 @end deffn
8677
8678
8679 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {intel} [@option{-family} <name>]
8680 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into Intel (former Altera) FPGAs.
8681 The families Cyclone III, Cyclone IV, Cyclone V, Cyclone 10, Arria II are supported.
8682 @c Arria V and Arria 10, MAX II, MAX V, MAX10)
8683
8684 For the option @option{-family} @var{name} is one of @var{cycloneiii cycloneiv cyclonev cyclone10 arriaii}.
8685 This is needed when the JTAG ID of the device is ambiguous (same ID is used for chips in different families).
8686
8687 As input file format the driver supports a '.rbf' (raw bitstream file) file. The '.rbf' file can be generated
8688 from a '.sof' file with @verb{|quartus_cpf -c blinker.sof blinker.rbf|}
8689
8690 Creates a new PLD device, an FPGA of the Cyclone III family, using the TAP named @verb{|cycloneiii.tap|}:
8691 @example
8692 pld create cycloneiii.pld intel -chain-position cycloneiii.tap -family cycloneiii
8693 @end example
8694
8695 @deffn {Command} {intel set_bscan} pld_name len
8696 Set boundary scan register length of FPGA @var{pld_name} to @var{len}. This is needed because the
8697 length can vary between chips with the same JTAG ID.
8698 @end deffn
8699
8700 @deffn {Command} {intel set_check_pos} pld_name pos
8701 Selects the position @var{pos} in the boundary-scan register. The bit at this
8702 position is checked after loading the bitstream and must be '1', which is the case when no error occurred.
8703 With a value of -1 for @var{pos} the check will be omitted.
8704 @end deffn
8705 @end deffn
8706
8707
8708 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {gowin}
8709 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into FPGAs from Gowin.
8710 It is possible to program the SRAM. Programming the flash is not supported.
8711 The files @verb{|.fs|} and @verb{|.bin|} generated by Gowin FPGA Designer are supported.
8712
8713 @deffn {Command} {gowin read_status} pld_name
8714 Reads and displays the status register
8715 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8716 @end deffn
8717
8718 @deffn {Command} {gowin read_user} pld_name
8719 Reads and displays the user register
8720 for FPGA @var{pld_name}.
8721 @end deffn
8722
8723 @deffn {Command} {gowin reload} pld_name
8724 Load the bitstream from external memory for
8725 FPGA @var{pld_name}. A.k.a. refresh.
8726 @end deffn
8727 @end deffn
8728
8729
8730 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {gatemate}
8731 This driver can be used to load the bitstream into GateMate FPGAs form CologneChip.
8732 The files @verb{|.bit|} and @verb{|.cfg|} both generated by p_r tool from CologneChip are supported.
8733 @end deffn
8734
8735
8736 @node General Commands
8737 @chapter General Commands
8738 @cindex commands
8739
8740 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8741 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8742 commands are documented elsewhere.
8743
8744 Intent:
8745 @itemize @bullet
8746 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8747 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8748 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8749 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8750
8751 @item @b{From the human}
8752 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8753 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8754
8755 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8756 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8757 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8758
8759 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8760 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8761 port is 6666.
8762 @end itemize
8763
8764
8765 @section Server Commands
8766
8767 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8768 Exits the current telnet session.
8769 @end deffn
8770
8771 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8772 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8773 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8774 Not every command provides helptext.
8775
8776 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8777 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8778 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8779 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8780 @end deffn
8781
8782 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8783 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8784 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8785 containing @var{string}.
8786 Not every command provides helptext.
8787 @end deffn
8788
8789 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8790 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8791 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8792 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8793 Useful in connection with script files
8794 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8795 @end deffn
8796
8797 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8798 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8799 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8800 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8801
8802 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, the command @command{shutdown}
8803 will be automatically executed to cause OpenOCD to exit.
8804
8805 It is possible to specify, in the TCL list @var{pre_shutdown_commands} , a
8806 set of commands to be automatically executed before @command{shutdown} , e.g.:
8807 @example
8808 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "Goodbye, my friend ..."@}
8809 lappend pre_shutdown_commands @{echo "see you soon !"@}
8810 @end example
8811 The commands in the list will be executed (in the same order they occupy
8812 in the list) before OpenOCD exits. If one of the commands in the list
8813 fails, then the remaining commands are not executed anymore while OpenOCD
8814 will proceed to quit.
8815 @end deffn
8816
8817 @anchor{debuglevel}
8818 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8819 @cindex message level
8820 Display debug level.
8821 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8822 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8823 Level 0 is error messages only;
8824 level 1 adds warnings;
8825 level 2 adds informational messages;
8826 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8827 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8828 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8829 the command line along with the location of that log
8830 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8831 @xref{Running}.
8832 @end deffn
8833
8834 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8835 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8836 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8837 @example
8838 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8839 @end example
8840 @end deffn
8841
8842 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8843 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8844 the default log output channel is stderr.
8845 @end deffn
8846
8847 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8848 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8849 @end deffn
8850
8851 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8852 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8853 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8854 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8855 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8856 @end deffn
8857
8858 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8859 @section Target State handling
8860 @cindex reset
8861 @cindex halt
8862 @cindex target initialization
8863
8864 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8865 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8866 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8867 a current target which is used to perform the
8868 various operations. The current target may be changed
8869 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8870 target which should become current.
8871
8872 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8873 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8874 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8875 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8876 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8877
8878 @emph{With no arguments}:
8879 list all available registers for the current target,
8880 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8881 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8882 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8883 are flagged as such.
8884
8885 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8886 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8887 bypassing any internal cache.
8888
8889 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8890 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8891 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8892 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8893 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8894 relevant module will flush such values.
8895
8896 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8897 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8898
8899 @example
8900 > reg
8901 ===== ARM registers
8902 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8903 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8904 (2) r2 (/32)
8905 ...
8906 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8907 >
8908 @end example
8909 @end deffn
8910
8911 @deffn {Command} {set_reg} dict
8912 Set register values of the target.
8913
8914 @itemize
8915 @item @var{dict} ... Tcl dictionary with pairs of register names and values.
8916 @end itemize
8917
8918 For example, the following command sets the value 0 to the program counter (pc)
8919 register and 0x1000 to the stack pointer (sp) register:
8920
8921 @example
8922 set_reg @{pc 0 sp 0x1000@}
8923 @end example
8924 @end deffn
8925
8926 @deffn {Command} {get_reg} [-force] list
8927 Get register values from the target and return them as Tcl dictionary with pairs
8928 of register names and values.
8929 If option "-force" is set, the register values are read directly from the
8930 target, bypassing any caching.
8931
8932 @itemize
8933 @item @var{list} ... List of register names
8934 @end itemize
8935
8936 For example, the following command retrieves the values from the program
8937 counter (pc) and stack pointer (sp) register:
8938
8939 @example
8940 get_reg @{pc sp@}
8941 @end example
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn {Command} {write_memory} address width data ['phys']
8945 This function provides an efficient way to write to the target memory from a Tcl
8946 script.
8947
8948 @itemize
8949 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8950 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8951 @item @var{data} ... Tcl list with the elements to write
8952 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8953 @end itemize
8954
8955 For example, the following command writes two 32 bit words into the target
8956 memory at address 0x20000000:
8957
8958 @example
8959 write_memory 0x20000000 32 @{0xdeadbeef 0x00230500@}
8960 @end example
8961 @end deffn
8962
8963 @deffn {Command} {read_memory} address width count ['phys']
8964 This function provides an efficient way to read the target memory from a Tcl
8965 script.
8966 A Tcl list containing the requested memory elements is returned by this function.
8967
8968 @itemize
8969 @item @var{address} ... target memory address
8970 @item @var{width} ... memory access bit size, can be 8, 16, 32 or 64
8971 @item @var{count} ... number of elements to read
8972 @item ['phys'] ... treat the memory address as physical instead of virtual address
8973 @end itemize
8974
8975 For example, the following command reads two 32 bit words from the target
8976 memory at address 0x20000000:
8977
8978 @example
8979 read_memory 0x20000000 32 2
8980 @end example
8981 @end deffn
8982
8983 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8984 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8985 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8986 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8987 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8988 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8989 (and enter debug mode).
8990 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8991
8992 @quotation Warning
8993 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8994 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8995 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8996 power mode by gating the core clock;
8997 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8998
8999 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
9000 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
9001 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
9002 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
9003 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
9004 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
9005
9006 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
9007 work with a JTAG debugger.
9008 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
9009 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9010 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
9011 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
9012 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
9013 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
9014 @end quotation
9015
9016 @end deffn
9017
9018 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
9019 Resume the target at its current code position,
9020 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
9021 @end deffn
9022
9023 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
9024 Single-step the target at its current code position,
9025 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
9026 @end deffn
9027
9028 @anchor{resetcommand}
9029 @deffn {Command} {reset}
9030 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
9031 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
9032 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
9033 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
9034 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
9035 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
9036
9037 The optional parameter specifies what should
9038 happen after the reset.
9039 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
9040 The other options will not work on all systems.
9041 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9042
9043 @itemize @minus
9044 @item @b{run} Let the target run
9045 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
9046 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
9047 @end itemize
9048 @end deffn
9049
9050 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
9051 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
9052 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
9053 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
9054 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
9055 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
9056 state.
9057 @end deffn
9058
9059 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
9060 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
9061 Set values of reset signals.
9062 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
9063 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
9064 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
9065 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
9066
9067 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9068 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
9069 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9070 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9071 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
9072 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
9073 the signal will not be modified.
9074
9075 @quotation Note
9076 TRST is specially handled.
9077 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9078 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9079 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9080 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9081 instead of the TRST signal.
9082 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9083 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9084 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9085 with handlers for that event.
9086 @end quotation
9087 @end deffn
9088
9089 @anchor{memoryaccess}
9090 @section Memory access commands
9091 @cindex memory access
9092
9093 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
9094 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
9095 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
9096 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
9097
9098 @enumerate
9099 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
9100 to change the current target.
9101 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
9102 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
9103 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
9104 @end enumerate
9105
9106 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
9107 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
9108 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
9109 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
9110 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
9111 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
9112 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
9113 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
9114 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
9115 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
9116 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
9117 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
9118 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
9119 (If you want to process the data instead of displaying it,
9120 see the @code{read_memory} primitives.)
9121 @end deffn
9122
9123 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
9124 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
9125 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
9126 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
9127 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
9128 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
9129 at the specified address @var{addr}.
9130 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
9131 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
9132 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
9133 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
9134 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
9135 @end deffn
9136
9137 @anchor{imageaccess}
9138 @section Image loading commands
9139 @cindex image loading
9140 @cindex image dumping
9141
9142 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
9143 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
9144 binary file named @var{filename}.
9145 @end deffn
9146
9147 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
9148 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
9149 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
9150 @end deffn
9151
9152 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
9153 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
9154 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
9155 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
9156 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
9157 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
9158 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
9159 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
9160 separately.
9161 @end deffn
9162
9163 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
9164 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
9165 The file format may optionally be specified
9166 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
9167 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
9168 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
9169 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
9170 @example
9171 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
9172 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
9173 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
9174 load_image $fname [expr @{$address - $foffset@}] bin \
9175 $address $length
9176 @}
9177 @end example
9178 @end deffn
9179
9180 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
9181 Displays image section sizes and addresses
9182 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
9183 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
9184 The file format may optionally be specified
9185 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9186 @end deffn
9187
9188 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9189 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9190 The file format may optionally be specified
9191 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9192 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
9193 @end deffn
9194
9195 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
9196 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
9197 The file format may optionally be specified
9198 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
9199 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
9200 @end deffn
9201
9202
9203 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
9204 @cindex breakpoint
9205 @cindex watchpoint
9206
9207 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
9208 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
9209 watchpoints.
9210 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
9211
9212 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
9213 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
9214 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
9215 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9216 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
9217 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
9218
9219 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
9220 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
9221 @end deffn
9222
9223 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
9224 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
9225 @end deffn
9226
9227 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
9228 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
9229 @end deffn
9230
9231 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
9232 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
9233 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
9234 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
9235 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
9236 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
9237 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
9238 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
9239 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
9240 @end deffn
9241
9242
9243 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
9244
9245 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
9246 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
9247 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
9248 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
9249 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
9250 running, can be used.
9251 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
9252 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
9253 applicable because of real-time constraints.
9254
9255 @quotation Note
9256 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
9257 @end quotation
9258
9259 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
9260 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
9261 communication, respectively.
9262
9263 @quotation Note
9264 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
9265 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
9266 example.
9267 @end quotation
9268
9269 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
9270 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
9271 of TCP/IP connections.
9272
9273 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
9274 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
9275 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
9276 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
9277 @var{size} bytes.
9278 @end deffn
9279
9280 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
9281 Start RTT.
9282 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
9283 @end deffn
9284
9285 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
9286 Stop RTT.
9287 @end deffn
9288
9289 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
9290 Display the polling interval.
9291 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
9292 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
9293 checked for new data.
9294 @end deffn
9295
9296 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
9297 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
9298 @end deffn
9299
9300 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
9301 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
9302 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
9303 @end deffn
9304
9305 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
9306 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
9307 @end deffn
9308
9309 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
9310 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
9311 @end deffn
9312
9313 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
9314 on the target device.
9315
9316 @example
9317 resume
9318
9319 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
9320 rtt start
9321
9322 rtt server start 9090 0
9323 @end example
9324
9325 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
9326 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
9327 TCP/IP port 9090.
9328
9329
9330 @section Misc Commands
9331
9332 @cindex profiling
9333 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
9334 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
9335 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
9336 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
9337 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
9338 limit the address range.
9339 @end deffn
9340
9341 @deffn {Command} {version} [git]
9342 Returns a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
9343 With option @option{git}, it returns the git version obtained at compile time
9344 through ``git describe''.
9345 @end deffn
9346
9347 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
9348 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
9349 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
9350 @end deffn
9351
9352 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9353 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
9354 @end deffn
9355
9356 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
9357 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
9358 @end deffn
9359
9360 @node Architecture and Core Commands
9361 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
9362 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
9363 @cindex Core Specific Commands
9364
9365 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
9366 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
9367 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
9368 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
9369
9370 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
9371 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
9372 @cindex tracing
9373 @cindex ETM
9374 @cindex ETB
9375
9376 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
9377 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
9378 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
9379
9380 @itemize
9381 @item
9382 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
9383 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
9384 supports such an interface.
9385 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
9386 and trace port support.)
9387 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
9388 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
9389 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
9390 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
9391 in the board-specific configuration file.
9392 @item
9393 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
9394 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
9395 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
9396 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
9397 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
9398 @end itemize
9399
9400 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
9401
9402 @quotation Issues
9403 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
9404 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
9405
9406 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
9407 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
9408 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
9409 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
9410 dummy trace port driver}.
9411
9412 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
9413 as well as tracing only during specific states
9414 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
9415
9416 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
9417 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
9418 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
9419 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
9420 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
9421
9422 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
9423 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
9424 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
9425 this original style of JTAG access.
9426 @end quotation
9427
9428 @subsection ETM Configuration
9429 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
9430
9431 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
9432 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
9433 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
9434
9435 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
9436 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
9437 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
9438 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
9439 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
9440 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
9441 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
9442 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
9443 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
9444
9445 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
9446 or @option{demultiplexed}.
9447 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
9448
9449 @quotation Warning
9450 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
9451 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
9452 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
9453 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
9454 @end quotation
9455
9456 @quotation Note
9457 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
9458 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
9459 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
9460 what CPU activities are traced.
9461 @end quotation
9462 @end deffn
9463
9464 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
9465 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
9466 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
9467 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
9468 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
9469 @end deffn
9470
9471 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
9472 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
9473 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
9474 Did trace data overflow?
9475 Was it triggered?
9476 @end deffn
9477
9478 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
9479 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
9480 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
9481 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
9482 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
9483
9484 @itemize
9485 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
9486 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
9487 The value is one of
9488 @option{none} (save nothing),
9489 @option{data} (save data),
9490 @option{address} (save addresses),
9491 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
9492 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
9493 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
9494 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
9495 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
9496 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
9497 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
9498 trace stream without an image of the code.
9499 @end itemize
9500 @end deffn
9501
9502 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9503 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
9504 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
9505 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
9506 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
9507
9508 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
9509 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
9510 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
9511 @end deffn
9512
9513 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
9514
9515 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
9516 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
9517 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
9518
9519 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
9520 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
9521 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
9522 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
9523 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
9524 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
9525 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
9526
9527 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
9528
9529 @itemize
9530 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
9531 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
9532 for instruction access within that function's body.
9533 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
9534 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
9535 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
9536 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
9537 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
9538 combining one of the above models with a counter.
9539 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
9540 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
9541 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
9542 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
9543 @item @emph{... more}
9544 @end itemize
9545
9546 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
9547 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
9548
9549 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
9550 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
9551 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
9552 @end deffn
9553
9554 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
9555 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
9556 @end deffn
9557
9558 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
9559 Opens an image file.
9560 @end deffn
9561
9562 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9563 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9564 @end deffn
9565
9566 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9567 Starts trace data collection.
9568 @end deffn
9569
9570 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9571 Stops trace data collection.
9572 @end deffn
9573
9574 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9575 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9576
9577 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9578
9579 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9580 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9581 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9582 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9583 any trace data collection.}
9584 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9585 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9586 @end deffn
9587 @end deffn
9588
9589 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9590 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9591 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9592 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9593 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9594 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9595 @end deffn
9596 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9597 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9598 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9599 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9600 trace trigger becomes active.
9601
9602 @itemize
9603 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9604 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9605 afterwards.
9606 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9607 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9608 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9609 what caused that event to happen.
9610 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9611 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9612 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9613 how the event caused trouble.
9614 @end itemize
9615 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9616 @end deffn
9617
9618 @end deffn
9619
9620 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9621 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9622 @cindex CTI
9623
9624 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9625 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9626 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9627 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9628 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9629 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9630
9631 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9632 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9633 @var{apn}.
9634 On ADIv5 DAP @var{apn} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9635 On ADIv6 DAP @var{apn} is the base address of the DAP AP the CTI is connected to.
9636 The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9637 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9638 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9639 including additional configuration.
9640 @end deffn
9641
9642 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9643 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9644 @end deffn
9645
9646 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9647 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9648 @end deffn
9649
9650 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9651 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9652 @end deffn
9653
9654 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9655 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9656 @end deffn
9657
9658 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9659 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9660 @end deffn
9661
9662 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9663 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9664 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9665 @end deffn
9666
9667 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9668 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9669 of the CTI.
9670 @end deffn
9671
9672 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9673 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9674 useful in TCL scripting.
9675 @end deffn
9676
9677 @section Generic ARM
9678 @cindex ARM
9679
9680 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9681 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9682 commands that may be available.
9683
9684 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9685 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9686 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9687 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9688 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9689 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9690 @end deffn
9691
9692 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9693 @cindex disassemble
9694 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9695 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9696 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9697 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9698 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9699 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9700 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9701
9702 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9703 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9704 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9705 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9706 with a handful of exceptions.
9707 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9708 @end deffn
9709
9710 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9711 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9712 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9713 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9714 and using the MCR instruction.
9715 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9716 an ARM register.)
9717 @end deffn
9718
9719 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9720 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9721 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9722 and the MRC instruction.
9723 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9724 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9725 an ARM register.)
9726 @end deffn
9727
9728 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9729 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9730 core mode if necessary.
9731 @end deffn
9732
9733 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9734 @cindex ARM semihosting
9735 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9736
9737 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9738 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9739 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9740 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9741 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9742 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9743 @end deffn
9744
9745 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_redirect} (@option{disable} | @option{tcp} <port> [@option{debug}|@option{stdio}|@option{all}])
9746 @cindex ARM semihosting
9747 Redirect semihosting messages to a specified TCP port.
9748
9749 This command redirects debug (READC, WRITEC and WRITE0) and stdio (READ, WRITE)
9750 semihosting operations to the specified TCP port.
9751 The command allows to select which type of operations to redirect (debug, stdio, all (default)).
9752
9753 Note: for stdio operations, only I/O from/to ':tt' file descriptors are redirected.
9754 @end deffn
9755
9756 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9757 @cindex ARM semihosting
9758 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9759
9760 @example
9761 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9762 @end example
9763
9764 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9765 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9766 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9767 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9768 @end deffn
9769
9770 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9771 @cindex ARM semihosting
9772 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9773 status.
9774
9775 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9776 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9777 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9778 debugger.
9779 @end deffn
9780
9781 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9782 @cindex ARM semihosting
9783 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9784
9785 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9786 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9787 the value returned by the target.
9788
9789 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9790 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9791 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9792 encountering a break.
9793
9794 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9795 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9796 to the debugger.
9797 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9798 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9799 request or equivalent").
9800
9801 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9802 this option (default: disabled).
9803 @end deffn
9804
9805 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_read_user_param}
9806 @cindex ARM semihosting
9807 Read parameter of the semihosting call from the target. Usable in
9808 semihosting-user-cmd-0x10* event handlers, returning a string.
9809
9810 When the target makes semihosting call with operation number from range 0x100-
9811 0x107, an optional string parameter can be passed to the server. This parameter
9812 is valid during the run of the event handlers and is accessible with this
9813 command.
9814 @end deffn
9815
9816 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_basedir} [dir]
9817 @cindex ARM semihosting
9818 Set the base directory for semihosting I/O, either an absolute path or a path relative to OpenOCD working directory.
9819 Use "." for the current directory.
9820 @end deffn
9821
9822 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9823 @cindex ARMv4
9824 @cindex ARMv5
9825
9826 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9827 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9828 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9829 variant.
9830
9831 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9832 @cindex ARM7
9833 @cindex ARM9
9834
9835 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9836 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9837 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9838 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9839
9840 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9841 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9842 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9843 instead of breakpoints.
9844 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9845
9846 This should be
9847 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9848 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9849 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9850 @end deffn
9851
9852 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9853 @cindex DCC
9854 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9855 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9856 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9857
9858 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9859 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9860 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9861 @end deffn
9862
9863 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9864 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9865 that don't check completion of the operation.
9866 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9867
9868 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9869 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9870 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9871 @end deffn
9872
9873 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9874 @cindex ARM9
9875
9876 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9877 integer processors.
9878 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9879
9880 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9881 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9882 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9883 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9884
9885 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9886 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9887 @cindex vector_catch
9888 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9889 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9890 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9891 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9892 to those hardware vectors.
9893
9894 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9895 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9896 vector catch hardware to intercept
9897 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9898 @option{none} of them,
9899 or a list with one or more of the following:
9900 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9901 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9902 @end deffn
9903
9904 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9905 @cindex ARM920T
9906
9907 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9908 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9909 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9910 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9911 and ARM9 commands.
9912
9913 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9914 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9915 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9916 @end deffn
9917
9918 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9919 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9920 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9921 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9922 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9923 (Not all registers can be written.)
9924 @end deffn
9925
9926 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9927 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9928 @end deffn
9929
9930 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9931 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9932 @end deffn
9933
9934 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9935 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9936
9937 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9938 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9939 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9940 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9941 and ARM9 commands.
9942
9943 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9944 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9945
9946 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9947 Print information about the caches found.
9948 @end deffn
9949
9950 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9951 @cindex ARM966E
9952
9953 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9954 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9955 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9956 and ARM9 commands.
9957
9958 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9959 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9960 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9961 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9962 ARM966E-S TRM.
9963 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9964 as required for BIST support.
9965 @end deffn
9966
9967 @subsection XScale specific commands
9968 @cindex XScale
9969
9970 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9971
9972 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9973 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9974 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9975 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9976 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9977 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9978 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9979
9980 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9981 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9982 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9983 the mini-IC.
9984
9985 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9986 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9987 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9988 code layout in memory:
9989 @example
9990 _vectors:
9991 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9992 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9993 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9994 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9995 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9996 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9997 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9998 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9999 .org 0x100
10000 .long real_reset_vector
10001 .long real_ui_handler
10002 .long real_swi_handler
10003 .long real_pf_abort
10004 .long real_data_abort
10005 .long 0 /* unused */
10006 .long real_irq_handler
10007 .long real_fiq_handler
10008 @end example
10009
10010 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
10011 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
10012 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
10013 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
10014 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
10015 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
10016 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
10017 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
10018 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
10019 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
10020 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
10021 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
10022 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
10023 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
10024 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
10025 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
10026 software.
10027
10028 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
10029 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
10030 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
10031 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
10032
10033 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
10034 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
10035 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
10036 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
10037 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
10038 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
10039 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
10040 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
10041 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
10042
10043 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
10044 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
10045
10046 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
10047 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
10048 @end deffn
10049
10050 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
10051 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
10052 @end deffn
10053
10054 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
10055 Displays information about the CPU caches.
10056 @end deffn
10057
10058 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
10059 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
10060 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
10061 @end deffn
10062
10063 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
10064 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
10065 @end deffn
10066
10067 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10068 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
10069 @end deffn
10070
10071 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
10072 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
10073 @end deffn
10074
10075 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10076 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
10077 @end deffn
10078
10079 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10080 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
10081 @end deffn
10082
10083 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
10084 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
10085 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
10086 and modifying how it is emptied.
10087 @end deffn
10088
10089 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
10090 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
10091 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
10092 The image @var{type} may be one of
10093 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
10094 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
10095 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
10096 @end deffn
10097
10098 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
10099 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
10100 @cindex vector_catch
10101 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
10102 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
10103
10104 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
10105 @example
10106 0x01 Trap Reset
10107 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
10108 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
10109 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
10110 0x10 Trap Data Abort
10111 0x20 reserved
10112 0x40 Trap IRQ
10113 0x80 Trap FIQ
10114 @end example
10115 @end deffn
10116
10117 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
10118 @cindex vector_table
10119
10120 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
10121 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
10122 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
10123 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
10124 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
10125
10126 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
10127
10128 @end deffn
10129
10130 @section ARMv6 Architecture
10131 @cindex ARMv6
10132
10133 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
10134 @cindex ARM11
10135
10136 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10137 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
10138 which is enabled by default.
10139 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10140 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
10141 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
10142 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
10143 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
10144 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
10145 @end deffn
10146
10147 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10148 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
10149 which is enabled by default.
10150 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
10151 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
10152 @end deffn
10153
10154 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
10155 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
10156 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
10157 they are disabled by default.
10158 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
10159 @end deffn
10160
10161 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
10162 @cindex vector_catch
10163 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
10164 coprocessor 14 register 7.
10165 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
10166
10167 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10168 for certain hardware events.
10169 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
10170 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
10171 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
10172 @end deffn
10173
10174 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
10175 @cindex ARMv7
10176 @cindex ARMv8
10177
10178 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
10179 @cindex Cortex-A
10180
10181 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
10182 display information about target caches
10183 @end deffn
10184
10185 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10186 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
10187 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
10188 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
10189 Defaults to 'off'.
10190 @end deffn
10191
10192 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
10193 Initialize core debug
10194 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10195 @end deffn
10196
10197 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
10198 Display/set the current SMP mode
10199 @end deffn
10200
10201 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
10202 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
10203 @end deffn
10204
10205 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10206 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10207 @end deffn
10208
10209 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
10210 configure l2x cache
10211 @end deffn
10212
10213 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
10214 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
10215 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
10216 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
10217 possible (4096) entries are printed.
10218 @end deffn
10219
10220 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
10221 @cindex Cortex-R
10222
10223 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
10224 Initialize core debug
10225 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
10226 @end deffn
10227
10228 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10229 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
10230 @end deffn
10231
10232
10233 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
10234 @cindex tracing
10235 @cindex SWO
10236 @cindex SWV
10237 @cindex TPIU
10238
10239 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
10240 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
10241 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
10242 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
10243
10244 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
10245 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
10246 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
10247 which causes quite some confusion.
10248 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
10249 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
10250
10251 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
10252 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
10253 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10254
10255 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
10256 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
10257 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
10258 @end deffn
10259
10260 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
10261 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
10262 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
10263 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
10264
10265 @itemize @bullet
10266 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
10267 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
10268 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
10269 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
10270
10271 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
10272 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
10273 @end itemize
10274 @end deffn
10275
10276 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
10277 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
10278 @end deffn
10279
10280 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
10281 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
10282 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
10283 at any time after the initialization, too.
10284 @end deffn
10285
10286 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
10287 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
10288 individually queried, to return its current value.
10289 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
10290 @end deffn
10291
10292 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
10293 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
10294 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
10295 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
10296
10297 @itemize @bullet
10298 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
10299 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
10300
10301 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU.
10302 On ADIv5 DAP @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10303 On ADIv6 DAP @var{ap_number} is the base address of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
10304
10305 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
10306 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
10307
10308 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
10309 protocol used for trace data:
10310 @itemize @minus
10311 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
10312 data bits (default);
10313 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
10314 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
10315 @end itemize
10316
10317 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
10318 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
10319 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
10320 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
10321 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
10322 of the TPIU.
10323
10324 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
10325 the destination of the trace data:
10326 @itemize @minus
10327 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
10328 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
10329 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
10330 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
10331 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
10332 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
10333 each connected client;
10334 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
10335 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
10336 either a regular file or a named pipe.
10337 @end itemize
10338
10339 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
10340 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
10341 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
10342 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
10343
10344 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
10345 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
10346 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
10347 maximum supported rate automatically.
10348
10349 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
10350 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
10351 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
10352
10353 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
10354 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
10355 default value is @var{0}.
10356 @end itemize
10357 @end deffn
10358
10359 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
10360 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
10361 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
10362 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
10363 data.
10364 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
10365 after the @command{init}.
10366 @end deffn
10367
10368 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
10369 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
10370 @end deffn
10371
10372
10373
10374 Example usage:
10375 @enumerate
10376 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
10377 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
10378 enough to:
10379 @example
10380 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
10381 ...
10382 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
10383 ...
10384 @end example
10385 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
10386 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
10387 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
10388 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
10389 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
10390 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
10391 @example
10392 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
10393 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
10394 @end example
10395 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
10396 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
10397 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
10398 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
10399 @example
10400 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
10401 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
10402 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
10403 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
10404 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
10405 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
10406 @end example
10407 @end enumerate
10408
10409 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
10410 @cindex tracing
10411 @cindex SWO
10412 @cindex SWV
10413 @cindex ITM
10414 @cindex ETM
10415
10416 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10417 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
10418 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
10419 @end deffn
10420
10421 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
10422 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
10423 @end deffn
10424
10425 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
10426 @cindex Cortex-M
10427
10428 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
10429 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
10430
10431 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
10432 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
10433 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
10434 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
10435 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
10436 the step command leaves with the core running.
10437
10438 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
10439 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
10440 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
10441 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
10442
10443 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
10444 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
10445 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
10446 does.
10447
10448 Default is @option{auto}.
10449 @end deffn
10450
10451 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
10452 @cindex vector_catch
10453 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
10454 for certain hardware events.
10455
10456 Parameters request interception of
10457 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
10458 @option{none} of them,
10459 or one or more of the following:
10460 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
10461 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
10462 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
10463 @option{irq_err},
10464 @option{state_err},
10465 @option{chk_err}, or
10466 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
10467 @option{reset}.
10468 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
10469 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
10470 are mapped to HardFault.
10471 UsageFault checks for
10472 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
10473 must also be explicitly enabled.
10474
10475 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
10476 @end deffn
10477
10478 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
10479 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
10480 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
10481
10482 @itemize @minus
10483 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
10484 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
10485 @end itemize
10486
10487 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
10488 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
10489 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
10490 to manually reset the peripherals.
10491 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10492
10493 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
10494 instead.
10495 @end deffn
10496
10497 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
10498 @cindex ARMv8-A
10499 @cindex aarch64
10500
10501 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
10502 Display information about target caches
10503 @end deffn
10504
10505 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
10506 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
10507 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
10508 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
10509 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
10510 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
10511 @end deffn
10512
10513 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
10514 @cindex disassemble
10515 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
10516 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
10517 @end deffn
10518
10519 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
10520 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
10521 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
10522 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
10523 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
10524 @end deffn
10525
10526 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
10527 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
10528 @option{on}.
10529 @end deffn
10530
10531 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
10532 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
10533 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
10534 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
10535 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
10536 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
10537 @end deffn
10538
10539 @deffn {Command} {$target_name pauth} [@option{off}|@option{on}]
10540 Enable or disable pointer authentication features.
10541 When pointer authentication is used on ARM cores, GDB asks GDB servers for an 8-bytes mask to remove signature bits added by pointer authentication.
10542 If this feature is enabled, OpenOCD provides GDB with an 8-bytes mask.
10543 Pointer authentication feature is broken until gdb 12.1, going to be fixed.
10544 Consider using a newer version of gdb if you want to enable pauth feature.
10545 The default configuration is @option{off}.
10546 @end deffn
10547
10548
10549 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
10550
10551 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
10552 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
10553
10554 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
10555
10556 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
10557 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
10558 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
10559 @end deffn
10560
10561 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
10562 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
10563 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
10564 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
10565 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
10566 @end deffn
10567
10568 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
10569
10570 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
10571 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
10572 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
10573 @end deffn
10574
10575 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
10576
10577 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
10578 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
10579 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
10580 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
10581 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
10582 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
10583 can be collected.
10584
10585 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
10586 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
10587 tooling.
10588
10589 @quotation Issues
10590 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
10591 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
10592 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
10593 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
10594
10595 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
10596 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
10597 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
10598 software operation on the CPU.
10599 @end quotation
10600
10601 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
10602 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
10603 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10604 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10605 @end deffn
10606
10607 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10608 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10609 @end deffn
10610
10611 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10612 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10613 control is disabled.
10614 @end deffn
10615
10616 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10617 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10618 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10619 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10620
10621 Supported trace formats:
10622 @itemize
10623 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10624 timing to be determined.
10625 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10626 addresses.
10627 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10628 @end itemize
10629 @end deffn
10630
10631 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10632 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10633 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10634 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10635
10636 Supported conditions:
10637 @itemize
10638 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10639 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10640 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10641 instruction matches start data and mask.
10642 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10643 instruction matches start data and mask.
10644 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10645 data and mask.
10646 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10647 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10648 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10649 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10650 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10651 @end itemize
10652 @end deffn
10653
10654 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10655 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10656 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10657 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10658
10659 Supported conditions:
10660 @itemize
10661 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10662 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10663 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10664 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10665 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10666 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10667 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10668 data and mask.
10669 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10670 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10671 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10672 @end itemize
10673 @end deffn
10674
10675 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10676 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10677
10678 Supported triggers:
10679 @itemize
10680 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10681 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10682 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10683 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10684 collection.
10685 @end itemize
10686 @end deffn
10687
10688 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10689
10690 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10691 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10692 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10693 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10694 @end deffn
10695
10696 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10697 Display trace configuration.
10698 @end deffn
10699
10700 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10701 Display trace collection status.
10702 @end deffn
10703
10704 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10705 Start manual trace collection.
10706 @end deffn
10707
10708 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10709 Stop manual trace collection.
10710 @end deffn
10711
10712 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10713 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10714 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10715 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10716 @option{size} options using DMA.
10717 @end deffn
10718
10719 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10720 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10721 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10722 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10723 @option{size} options using DMA.
10724 @end deffn
10725
10726 @section Intel Architecture
10727
10728 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10729 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10730 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10731 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10732 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10733 @itemize
10734 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10735 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10736 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10737 @end itemize
10738
10739 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10740 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10741 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10742
10743 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10744 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10745 @end deffn
10746
10747 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10748 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10749 @end deffn
10750
10751 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10752 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10753 @end deffn
10754
10755 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10756 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10757 @end deffn
10758
10759 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10760 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10761 @end deffn
10762
10763 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10764 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10765 @end deffn
10766
10767 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10768
10769 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10770 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10771
10772 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10773 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10774 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10775 @end deffn
10776 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10777 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10778
10779 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10780
10781 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10782 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10783 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10784 @end deffn
10785
10786 @subsection Registers commands
10787 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10788 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10789 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10790
10791 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10792
10793 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10794 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10795 and "timer" groups.
10796
10797 @emph{example:}
10798 @example
10799 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10800 @end example
10801
10802 @end deffn
10803
10804 @section RISC-V Architecture
10805
10806 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10807 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10808 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10809 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10810 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10811 implement version 0.11.
10812
10813 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10814
10815 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10816 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10817 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10818
10819 @subsection Vector Registers
10820
10821 For harts that implement the vector extension, OpenOCD provides access to the
10822 relevant CSRs, as well as the vector registers (v0-v31). The size of each
10823 vector register is dependent on the value of vlenb. RISC-V allows each vector
10824 register to be divided into selected-width elements, and this division can be
10825 changed at run-time. Because OpenOCD cannot update register definitions at
10826 run-time, it exposes each vector register to gdb as a union of fields of
10827 vectors so that users can easily access individual bytes, shorts, words,
10828 longs, and quads inside each vector register. It is left to gdb or
10829 higher-level debuggers to present this data in a more intuitive format.
10830
10831 In the XML register description, the vector registers (when vlenb=16) look as
10832 follows:
10833
10834 @example
10835 <feature name="org.gnu.gdb.riscv.vector">
10836 <vector id="bytes" type="uint8" count="16"/>
10837 <vector id="shorts" type="uint16" count="8"/>
10838 <vector id="words" type="uint32" count="4"/>
10839 <vector id="longs" type="uint64" count="2"/>
10840 <vector id="quads" type="uint128" count="1"/>
10841 <union id="riscv_vector">
10842 <field name="b" type="bytes"/>
10843 <field name="s" type="shorts"/>
10844 <field name="w" type="words"/>
10845 <field name="l" type="longs"/>
10846 <field name="q" type="quads"/>
10847 </union>
10848 <reg name="v0" bitsize="128" regnum="4162" save-restore="no"
10849 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10850 ...
10851 <reg name="v31" bitsize="128" regnum="4193" save-restore="no"
10852 type="riscv_vector" group="vector"/>
10853 </feature>
10854 @end example
10855
10856 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10857
10858 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10859 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10860 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10861 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10862 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10863 named @code{csr<n>}.
10864
10865 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10866 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10867 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10868 CSRs.
10869
10870 @example
10871 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10872 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10873
10874 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10875 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10876
10877 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10878 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10879 @end example
10880 @end deffn
10881
10882 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10883 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10884 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10885 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10886 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10887 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10888 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10889 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10890
10891 @example
10892 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10893 # under the name "custom16":
10894 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10895
10896 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10897 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10898 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10899
10900 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10901 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10902 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10903 @end example
10904 @end deffn
10905
10906 @deffn {Command} {riscv info}
10907 Displays some information OpenOCD detected about the target.
10908 @end deffn
10909
10910 @deffn {Command} {riscv reset_delays} [wait]
10911 OpenOCD learns how many Run-Test/Idle cycles are required between scans to avoid
10912 encountering the target being busy. This command resets those learned values
10913 after `wait` scans. It's only useful for testing OpenOCD itself.
10914 @end deffn
10915
10916 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10917 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10918 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10919 @end deffn
10920
10921 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10922 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10923 deasserted.
10924 @end deffn
10925
10926 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
10927 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
10928 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
10929
10930 Available methods are:
10931 @itemize
10932 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
10933 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
10934 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
10935 @end itemize
10936
10937 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
10938 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
10939
10940 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
10941 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
10942 @end deffn
10943
10944 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10945 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10946 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10947 on physical memory.
10948 @end deffn
10949
10950 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10951 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10952 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10953 performed on physical memory.
10954 @end deffn
10955
10956 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10957 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10958 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10959 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10960 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10961 race condition problem in your code.
10962
10963 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10964 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10965 @end deffn
10966
10967 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10968 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10969 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10970 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10971 values.
10972
10973 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10974 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10975 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10976 @end deffn
10977
10978 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10979 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10980 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10981 @end deffn
10982
10983 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10984 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10985 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10986 @end deffn
10987
10988 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10989 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10990 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10991 @end deffn
10992
10993 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10994 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10995 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10996 @end deffn
10997
10998 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10999
11000 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
11001 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
11002 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
11003 @example
11004 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
11005 riscv authdata_write [expr @{$challenge + 1@}]
11006 @end example
11007
11008 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
11009 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
11010 @end deffn
11011
11012 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
11013 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
11014 @end deffn
11015
11016 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
11017
11018 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
11019 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
11020
11021 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
11022 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
11023 @end deffn
11024
11025 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
11026 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
11027 @end deffn
11028
11029 @section ARC Architecture
11030 @cindex ARC
11031
11032 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
11033 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
11034 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
11035 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
11036 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
11037 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
11038 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
11039 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
11040 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
11041 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
11042 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
11043 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
11044 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
11045 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
11046 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
11047
11048
11049 @subsection General ARC commands
11050
11051 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
11052
11053 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
11054 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
11055 arguments:
11056
11057 @itemize @bullet
11058
11059 @item @code{-name} name
11060 @*Name of a register.
11061
11062 @item @code{-num} number
11063 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
11064
11065 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
11066 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
11067
11068 @end itemize
11069
11070 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
11071
11072 @itemize @bullet
11073
11074 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
11075 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
11076 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
11077 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
11078 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
11079 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
11080
11081 @item @code{-core}
11082 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
11083 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
11084 spaces.
11085
11086 @item @code{-bcr}
11087 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
11088 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
11089 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
11090 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
11091 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
11092
11093 @item @code{-type} type_name
11094 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
11095 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
11096
11097 @item @code{-g}
11098 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
11099 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
11100 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
11101 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
11102 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
11103
11104 @end itemize
11105
11106 @end deffn
11107
11108 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
11109 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
11110 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
11111 @end deffn
11112
11113 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
11114 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
11115 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
11116 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
11117 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
11118 startbit endbit}.
11119 @end deffn
11120
11121 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
11122 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
11123 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
11124 @end deffn
11125
11126 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
11127 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
11128 as an argument for a single command invocation.
11129 @end deffn
11130
11131 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
11132
11133 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
11134 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
11135 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
11136 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
11137
11138 @end deffn
11139
11140 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
11141 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
11142 registers.
11143 @end deffn
11144
11145 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
11146 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
11147 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
11148 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
11149
11150 @end deffn
11151
11152 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
11153 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
11154 registers.
11155 @end deffn
11156
11157 @section STM8 Architecture
11158 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
11159 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
11160
11161 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
11162 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
11163
11164 @section Xtensa Architecture
11165
11166 Xtensa is a highly-customizable, user-extensible microprocessor and DSP
11167 architecture for complex embedded systems provided by Cadence Design
11168 Systems, Inc. See the
11169 @uref{https://www.cadence.com/en_US/home/tools/ip/tensilica-ip.html, Tensilica IP}
11170 website for additional information and documentation.
11171
11172 OpenOCD supports generic Xtensa processor implementations which can be customized by
11173 providing a core-specific configuration file which describes every enabled
11174 Xtensa architecture option, e.g. number of address registers, exceptions, reduced
11175 size instructions support, memory banks configuration etc. OpenOCD also supports SMP
11176 configurations for Xtensa processors with any number of cores and allows configuring
11177 their debug interconnect (termed "break/stall networks"), which control how debug
11178 signals are distributed among cores. Xtensa "break networks" are compatible with
11179 ARM's Cross Trigger Interface (CTI). OpenOCD implements both generic Xtensa targets
11180 as well as several Espressif Xtensa-based chips from the
11181 @uref{https://www.espressif.com/en/products/socs, ESP32 family}.
11182
11183 OCD sessions for Xtensa processor and DSP targets are accessed via the Xtensa
11184 Debug Module (XDM), which provides external connectivity either through a
11185 traditional JTAG interface or an ARM DAP interface. If used, the DAP interface
11186 can control Xtensa targets through JTAG or SWD probes.
11187
11188 @subsection Xtensa Core Configuration
11189
11190 Due to the high level of configurability in Xtensa cores, the Xtensa target
11191 configuration comprises two categories:
11192
11193 @enumerate
11194 @item Base Xtensa support common to all core configurations, and
11195 @item Core-specific support as configured for individual cores.
11196 @end enumerate
11197
11198 All common Xtensa support is built into the OpenOCD Xtensa target layer and
11199 is enabled through a combination of TCL scripts: the target-specific
11200 @file{target/xtensa.cfg} and a board-specific @file{board/xtensa-*.cfg},
11201 similar to other target architectures.
11202
11203 Importantly, core-specific configuration information must be provided by
11204 the user, and takes the form of an @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} TCL script that
11205 defines the core's configurable features through a series of Xtensa
11206 configuration commands (detailed below).
11207
11208 This core-specific @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} file is typically either:
11209
11210 @itemize @bullet
11211 @item Located within the Xtensa core configuration build as
11212 @file{src/config/xtensa-core-openocd.cfg}, or
11213 @item Generated by running the command @code{xt-gdb --dump-oocd-config}
11214 from the Xtensa processor tool-chain's command-line tools.
11215 @end itemize
11216
11217 NOTE: @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} must match the target Xtensa hardware
11218 connected to OpenOCD.
11219
11220 Some example Xtensa configurations are bundled with OpenOCD for reference:
11221 @itemize @bullet
11222 @item Cadence Palladium VDebug emulation target. The user can combine their
11223 @file{xtensa-core-XXX.cfg} with the provided
11224 @file{board/xtensa-palladium-vdebug.cfg} to debug an emulated Xtensa RTL design.
11225 @item NXP MIMXRT685-EVK evaluation kit. The relevant configuration files are
11226 @file{board/xtensa-rt685-jlink.cfg} and @file{board/xtensa-core-nxp_rt600.cfg}.
11227 Additional information is provided by
11228 @uref{https://www.nxp.com/design/development-boards/i-mx-evaluation-and-development-boards/i-mx-rt600-evaluation-kit:MIMXRT685-EVK,
11229 NXP}.
11230 @end itemize
11231
11232 @subsection Xtensa Configuration Commands
11233
11234 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtdef} (@option{LX}|@option{NX})
11235 Configure the Xtensa target architecture. Currently, Xtensa support is limited
11236 to LX6, LX7, and NX cores.
11237 @end deffn
11238
11239 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtopt} option value
11240 Configure Xtensa target options that are relevant to the debug subsystem.
11241 @var{option} is one of: @option{arnum}, @option{windowed},
11242 @option{cpenable}, @option{exceptions}, @option{intnum}, @option{hipriints},
11243 @option{excmlevel}, @option{intlevels}, @option{debuglevel},
11244 @option{ibreaknum}, or @option{dbreaknum}. @var{value} is an integer with
11245 the exact range determined by each particular option.
11246
11247 NOTE: Some options are specific to Xtensa LX or Xtensa NX architecture, while
11248 others may be common to both but have different valid ranges.
11249 @end deffn
11250
11251 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{iram}|@option{dram}|@option{sram}|@option{irom}|@option{drom}|@option{srom}) baseaddr bytes
11252 Configure Xtensa target memory. Memory type determines access rights,
11253 where RAMs are read/write while ROMs are read-only. @var{baseaddr} and
11254 @var{bytes} are both integers, typically hexadecimal and decimal, respectively.
11255 @end deffn
11256
11257 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmem} (@option{icache}|@option{dcache}) linebytes cachebytes ways [writeback]
11258 Configure Xtensa processor cache. All parameters are required except for
11259 the optional @option{writeback} parameter; all are integers.
11260 @end deffn
11261
11262 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmpu} numfgseg minsegsz lockable execonly
11263 Configure an Xtensa Memory Protection Unit (MPU). MPUs can restrict access
11264 and/or control cacheability of specific address ranges, but are lighter-weight
11265 than a full traditional MMU. All parameters are required; all are integers.
11266 @end deffn
11267
11268 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtmmu} numirefillentries numdrefillentries
11269 (Xtensa-LX only) Configure an Xtensa Memory Management Unit (MMU). Both
11270 parameters are required; both are integers.
11271 @end deffn
11272
11273 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregs} numregs
11274 Configure the total number of registers for the Xtensa core. Configuration
11275 logic expects to subsequently process this number of @code{xtensa xtreg}
11276 definitions. @var{numregs} is an integer.
11277 @end deffn
11278
11279 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtregfmt} (@option{sparse}|@option{contiguous}) [general]
11280 Configure the type of register map used by GDB to access the Xtensa core.
11281 Generic Xtensa tools (e.g. xt-gdb) require @option{sparse} mapping (default) while
11282 Espressif tools expect @option{contiguous} mapping. Contiguous mapping takes an
11283 additional, optional integer parameter @option{numgregs}, which specifies the number
11284 of general registers used in handling g/G packets.
11285 @end deffn
11286
11287 @deffn {Config Command} {xtensa xtreg} name offset
11288 Configure an Xtensa core register. All core registers are 32 bits wide,
11289 while TIE and user registers may have variable widths. @var{name} is a
11290 character string identifier while @var{offset} is a hexadecimal integer.
11291 @end deffn
11292
11293 @subsection Xtensa Operation Commands
11294
11295 @deffn {Command} {xtensa maskisr} (@option{on}|@option{off})
11296 (Xtensa-LX only) Mask or unmask Xtensa interrupts during instruction step.
11297 When masked, an interrupt that occurs during a step operation is handled and
11298 its ISR is executed, with the user's debug session returning after potentially
11299 executing many instructions. When unmasked, a triggered interrupt will result
11300 in execution progressing the requested number of instructions into the relevant
11301 vector/ISR code.
11302 @end deffn
11303
11304 @deffn {Command} {xtensa set_permissive} (0|1)
11305 By default accessing memory beyond defined regions is forbidden. This commnd controls memory access address check.
11306 When set to (1), skips access controls and address range check before read/write memory.
11307 @end deffn
11308
11309 @deffn {Command} {xtensa smpbreak} [none|breakinout|runstall] | [BreakIn] [BreakOut] [RunStallIn] [DebugModeOut]
11310 Configures debug signals connection ("break network") for currently selected core.
11311 @itemize @bullet
11312 @item @code{none} - Core's "break/stall network" is disconnected. Core is not affected by any debug
11313 signal from other cores.
11314 @item @code{breakinout} - Core's "break network" is fully connected (break inputs and outputs are enabled).
11315 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores and send such signals to them. For example when another core
11316 is stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too and vice versa.
11317 @item @code{runstall} - Core's "stall network" is fully connected (stall inputs and outputs are enabled).
11318 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11319 @item @code{BreakIn} - Core's "break-in" signal is enabled.
11320 Core will receive debug break signals from other cores. For example when another core is
11321 stopped due to breakpoint hit this core will be stopped too.
11322 @item @code{BreakOut} - Core's "break-out" signal is enabled.
11323 Core will send debug break signal to other cores. For example when this core is
11324 stopped due to breakpoint hit other cores with enabled break-in signals will be stopped too.
11325 @item @code{RunStallIn} - Core's "runstall-in" signal is enabled.
11326 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11327 @item @code{DebugModeOut} - Core's "debugmode-out" signal is enabled.
11328 This feature is not well implemented and tested yet.
11329 @end itemize
11330 @end deffn
11331
11332 @deffn {Command} {xtensa exe} <ascii-encoded hexadecimal instruction bytes>
11333 Execute arbitrary instruction(s) provided as an ascii string. The string represents an integer
11334 number of instruction bytes, thus its length must be even.
11335 @end deffn
11336
11337 @subsection Xtensa Performance Monitor Configuration
11338
11339 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_enable} <counter_id> <select> [mask] [kernelcnt] [tracelevel]
11340 Enable and start performance counter.
11341 @itemize @bullet
11342 @item @code{counter_id} - Counter ID (0-1).
11343 @item @code{select} - Selects performance metric to be counted by the counter,
11344 e.g. 0 - CPU cycles, 2 - retired instructions.
11345 @item @code{mask} - Selects input subsets to be counted (counter will
11346 increment only once even if more than one condition corresponding to a mask bit occurs).
11347 @item @code{kernelcnt} - 0 - count events with "CINTLEVEL <= tracelevel",
11348 1 - count events with "CINTLEVEL > tracelevel".
11349 @item @code{tracelevel} - Compares this value to "CINTLEVEL" when deciding
11350 whether to count.
11351 @end itemize
11352 @end deffn
11353
11354 @deffn {Command} {xtensa perfmon_dump} (counter_id)
11355 Dump performance counter value. If no argument specified, dumps all counters.
11356 @end deffn
11357
11358 @subsection Xtensa Trace Configuration
11359
11360 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestart} [pc <pcval>/[<maskbitcount>]] [after <n> [ins|words]]
11361 Set up and start a HW trace. Optionally set PC address range to trigger tracing stop when reached during program execution.
11362 This command also allows to specify the amount of data to capture after stop trigger activation.
11363 @itemize @bullet
11364 @item @code{pcval} - PC value which will trigger trace data collection stop.
11365 @item @code{maskbitcount} - PC value mask.
11366 @item @code{n} - Maximum number of instructions/words to capture after trace stop trigger.
11367 @end itemize
11368 @end deffn
11369
11370 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracestop}
11371 Stop current trace as started by the tracestart command.
11372 @end deffn
11373
11374 @deffn {Command} {xtensa tracedump} <outfile>
11375 Dump trace memory to a file.
11376 @end deffn
11377
11378 @section Espressif Specific Commands
11379
11380 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (start <destination> [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11381 Starts
11382 @uref{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#application-level-tracing-library, application level tracing}.
11383 Data will be stored to specified destination. Available destinations are:
11384 @itemize @bullet
11385 @item @code{file://<outfile>} - Save trace logs into file.
11386 @item @code{tcp://<host>:<port>} - Send trace logs to tcp port on specified host. OpenOCD will act as a tcp client.
11387 @item @code{con:} - Print trace logs to the stdout.
11388 @end itemize
11389 Other parameters will be same for each destination.
11390 @itemize @bullet
11391 @item @code{poll_period} - trace data polling period in ms.
11392 @item @code{trace_size} - maximum trace data size.
11393 Tracing will be stopped automatically when that amount is reached.
11394 Use "-1" to disable the limitation.
11395 @item @code{stop_tmo} - Data reception timeout in ms.
11396 Tracing will be stopped automatically when no data is received within that period.
11397 @item @code{wait4halt} - if non-zero then wait for target to be halted before tracing start.
11398 @item @code{skip_size} - amount of tracing data to be skipped before writing it to destination.
11399 @end itemize
11400 @end deffn
11401
11402 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (stop)
11403 Stops tracing started with above command.
11404 @end deffn
11405
11406 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (status)
11407 Requests ongoing tracing status.
11408 @end deffn
11409
11410 @deffn {Command} {esp apptrace} (dump file://<outfile>)
11411 Dumps tracing data from target buffer. It can be useful to dump the latest data
11412 buffered on target for post-mortem analysis. For example when target starts tracing automatically
11413 w/o OpenOCD command and keeps only the latest data window which fit into the buffer.
11414 @uref{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#application-level-tracing-library, application level tracing}.
11415 Data will be stored to specified destination.
11416 @end deffn
11417
11418 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (start file://<outfile1> [file://<outfile2>] [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11419 Starts @uref{https://www.segger.com/products/development-tools/systemview/, SEGGER SystemView}
11420 compatible tracing. Data will be stored to specified destination.
11421 For dual-core chips traces from every core will be saved to separate files.
11422 Resulting files can be open in "SEGGER SystemView" application.
11423 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11424 The meaning of the arguments is identical to @command{esp apptrace start}.
11425 @end deffn
11426
11427 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (stop)
11428 Stops SystremView compatible tracing started with above command.
11429 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11430 @end deffn
11431
11432 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview} (status)
11433 Requests ongoing SystremView compatible tracing status.
11434 @url{https://docs.espressif.com/projects/esp-idf/en/latest/esp32/api-guides/app_trace.html#openocd-systemview-tracing-command-options}
11435 @end deffn
11436
11437 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (start file://<outfile> [<poll_period> [<trace_size> [<stop_tmo> [<wait4halt> [<skip_size>]]]]])
11438 This command is identical to @command{esp sysview start}, but uses Espressif multi-core extension to
11439 @uref{https://www.segger.com/products/development-tools/systemview/, SEGGER SystemView} data format.
11440 Data will be stored to specified destination. Tracing data from all cores are saved in the same file.
11441 The meaning of the arguments is identical to @command{esp sysview start}.
11442 @end deffn
11443
11444 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (stop)
11445 Stops Espressif multi-core SystremView tracing started with above command.
11446 @end deffn
11447
11448 @deffn {Command} {esp sysview_mcore} (status)
11449 Requests ongoing Espressif multi-core SystremView tracing status.
11450 @end deffn
11451
11452 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
11453 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
11454 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
11455 @cindex tracing
11456 @cindex libdcc
11457 @cindex DCC
11458 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
11459 the target uses appropriate libraries.
11460 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
11461 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
11462
11463 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
11464 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
11465 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
11466 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
11467 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
11468 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
11469
11470 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
11471 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
11472 arrays of various size integers from the target,
11473 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
11474 The target being debugged may
11475 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
11476 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
11477 each supported by a command:
11478
11479 @itemize
11480 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
11481 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
11482 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
11483 finding out how some fault was triggered.
11484
11485 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
11486 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
11487 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
11488
11489 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
11490 and then displayed at any time.
11491 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
11492
11493 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
11494 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
11495 @end itemize
11496
11497 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
11498 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
11499 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
11500 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
11501 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
11502 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
11503 does the same thing.
11504
11505 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
11506 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
11507 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
11508 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
11509 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
11510
11511 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
11512 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
11513 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
11514 @end deffn
11515
11516 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
11517 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
11518 in the order they triggered.
11519 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
11520 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
11521 history records.
11522 @end deffn
11523
11524 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
11525 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
11526 they have been triggered.
11527 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
11528 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
11529 and associates it with that identifier.
11530
11531 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
11532 are not related except by this command.
11533 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
11534 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
11535 @end deffn
11536
11537
11538 @node JTAG Commands
11539 @chapter JTAG Commands
11540 @cindex JTAG Commands
11541 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
11542 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
11543 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
11544 may be needed to work with targets which require special
11545 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
11546
11547 To use these commands you will need to understand some
11548 of the basics of JTAG, including:
11549
11550 @itemize @bullet
11551 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
11552 devices such as a CPUs.
11553 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
11554 standard state machine (in parallel)
11555 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
11556 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
11557 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
11558 while the reading previous ones.
11559 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
11560 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
11561 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
11562 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
11563 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
11564 registers.
11565 @end itemize
11566
11567 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
11568
11569 These commands are used by developers who need to access
11570 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
11571 the order of TAP state transitions.
11572 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
11573 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
11574 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
11575 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
11576 these commands are not available.
11577
11578 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11579 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
11580 that specify the entire register.
11581 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
11582 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
11583 The return value holds the original value of each
11584 of those fields.
11585
11586 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
11587 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
11588 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
11589 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
11590 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
11591
11592 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
11593 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
11594
11595 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11596 in that state.
11597 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
11598 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11599 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11600
11601 @quotation Warning
11602 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
11603 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
11604 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
11605 data registers, which may have different lengths.
11606 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
11607 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
11608 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
11609 (by connecting a different scan chain).
11610 @end quotation
11611 @end deffn
11612
11613 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
11614 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
11615 This may be used for performance tuning.
11616
11617 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
11618 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
11619 not change with the amount of data which is written.
11620 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
11621 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
11622 instead of batching them into larger operations.
11623 @end deffn
11624
11625 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
11626 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
11627 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
11628 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
11629 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
11630 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
11631
11632 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
11633 in that state.
11634 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
11635 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
11636 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
11637
11638 @quotation Note
11639 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
11640 register values, unlike data register values.
11641 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
11642 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
11643 @end quotation
11644 @end deffn
11645
11646 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
11647 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
11648 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
11649 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
11650 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
11651 Then, in a series of single state transitions
11652 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
11653 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
11654 The final state must also be stable.
11655 @end deffn
11656
11657 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
11658 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
11659 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
11660 Instructions often need some time
11661 to execute before they take effect.
11662 @end deffn
11663
11664 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
11665 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
11666
11667 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11668 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
11669 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
11670 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
11671 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
11672 @end deffn
11673
11674 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
11675 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
11676 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
11677 must also be enabled.
11678 Default is enabled.
11679 @end deffn
11680
11681 @section TAP state names
11682 @cindex TAP state names
11683
11684 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
11685 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
11686 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
11687 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
11688
11689 @itemize @bullet
11690 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
11691 acts as if TRST were pulsed
11692 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
11693 @item @b{DRSELECT}
11694 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
11695 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11696 through the data register
11697 @item @b{DREXIT1}
11698 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
11699 for update or more shifting
11700 @item @b{DREXIT2}
11701 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
11702 @item @b{IRSELECT}
11703 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
11704 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
11705 through the instruction register
11706 @item @b{IREXIT1}
11707 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
11708 for update or more shifting
11709 @item @b{IREXIT2}
11710 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
11711 @end itemize
11712
11713 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
11714 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
11715 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
11716 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
11717
11718 @itemize @bullet
11719 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
11720 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
11721 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
11722 may not be as expected.
11723 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
11724 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
11725 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
11726 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
11727 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
11728 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
11729 @end itemize
11730
11731 @node Boundary Scan Commands
11732 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
11733
11734 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
11735 boundary scan based hardware testing.
11736 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
11737 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
11738
11739 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
11740 @cindex Serial Vector Format
11741 @cindex SVF
11742
11743 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
11744 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
11745 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11746 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11747
11748 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{-quiet}] @
11749 [@option{-nil}] [@option{-progress}] [@option{-ignore_error}] @
11750 [@option{-noreset}] [@option{-addcycles @var{cyclecount}}]
11751 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11752 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
11753
11754 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
11755 affect their semantics.
11756
11757 Command options:
11758 @itemize @minus
11759 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
11760 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
11761 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
11762 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
11763 @item @option{-quiet} do not log every command before execution;
11764 @item @option{-nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
11765 on the real interface;
11766 @item @option{-progress} enable progress indication;
11767 @item @option{-ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
11768 errors.
11769 @item @option{-noreset} omit JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) before executing
11770 content of the SVF file;
11771 @item @option{-addcycles @var{cyclecount}} inject @var{cyclecount} number of
11772 additional TCLK cycles after each SDR scan instruction;
11773 @end itemize
11774 @end deffn
11775
11776 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11777 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
11778 @cindex XSVF
11779
11780 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
11781 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
11782 Xilinx devices.
11783 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
11784 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
11785
11786 @quotation Important
11787 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
11788 @end quotation
11789
11790 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
11791 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
11792 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
11793 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
11794 that TAP.
11795 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
11796 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
11797 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
11798 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
11799 @end deffn
11800
11801 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
11802 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
11803 after building the software.
11804 You may find them useful:
11805
11806 @itemize
11807 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
11808 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
11809 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
11810 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
11811 @end itemize
11812
11813 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
11814 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
11815 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
11816 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
11817 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
11818 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
11819 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
11820
11821
11822 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
11823 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
11824 @cindex IPDBG
11825
11826 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
11827 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
11828 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
11829 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
11830 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
11831 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
11832
11833 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
11834 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
11835
11836 Command options:
11837 @itemize @bullet
11838 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
11839 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
11840 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
11841 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
11842 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
11843 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
11844 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
11845 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
11846 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
11847 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
11848 shift data through vir can be configured.
11849 @end itemize
11850 @end deffn
11851
11852 Examples:
11853 @example
11854 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
11855 @end example
11856 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
11857 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
11858
11859 @example
11860 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
11861 @end example
11862 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
11863 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
11864
11865 @node Utility Commands
11866 @chapter Utility Commands
11867 @cindex Utility Commands
11868
11869 @section RAM testing
11870 @cindex RAM testing
11871
11872 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
11873 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
11874 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
11875 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
11876 hardware problems.
11877
11878 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
11879 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
11880 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
11881 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
11882
11883 Load the memory testing functions with
11884
11885 @example
11886 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
11887 @end example
11888
11889 to get access to the following facilities:
11890
11891 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
11892 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
11893 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
11894 @end deffn
11895
11896 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
11897 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
11898 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
11899 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
11900 @end deffn
11901
11902 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
11903 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
11904 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
11905 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
11906 @end deffn
11907
11908 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
11909 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
11910 @end deffn
11911
11912 @section Firmware recovery helpers
11913 @cindex Firmware recovery
11914
11915 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
11916 devices recovery with JTAG.
11917
11918 For quickstart instructions run:
11919 @example
11920 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
11921 @end example
11922
11923 @node GDB and OpenOCD
11924 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
11925 @cindex GDB
11926 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
11927 to debug remote targets.
11928 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
11929
11930 @itemize
11931 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
11932 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
11933 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
11934 as shown in this chapter.
11935 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
11936 that also will probably need to be configured.
11937 @end itemize
11938
11939 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
11940 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
11941 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
11942 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
11943 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
11944 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
11945
11946 @section Connecting to GDB
11947 @cindex Connecting to GDB
11948 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
11949 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
11950 errors, which has since been fixed; see
11951 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
11952
11953 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
11954
11955 @enumerate
11956 @item
11957 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
11958 @example
11959 target extended-remote localhost:3333
11960 @end example
11961 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
11962
11963 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
11964 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
11965 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
11966
11967 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
11968 remote command above that becomes:
11969 @example
11970 tar ext :3333
11971 @end example
11972
11973 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
11974 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
11975 available through the command:
11976 @example
11977 target remote localhost:3333
11978 @end example
11979
11980 @item
11981 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
11982 @example
11983 target extended-remote | \
11984 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
11985 @end example
11986 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
11987 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
11988 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
11989 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
11990 @end enumerate
11991
11992 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
11993 GDB command line.
11994
11995 @section Sample GDB session startup
11996
11997 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11998 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11999 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
12000 small ARM program.
12001 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
12002 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
12003
12004 @example
12005 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
12006 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
12007 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
12008 ...
12009 (gdb) monitor reset halt
12010 ...
12011 (gdb) load
12012 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
12013 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
12014 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
12015 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
12016 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
12017 (gdb) continue
12018 Continuing.
12019 ...
12020 @end example
12021
12022 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
12023 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
12024 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
12025 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
12026
12027 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
12028
12029 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
12030 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
12031 packet size and the device's memory map.
12032 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
12033 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
12034 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
12035
12036 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
12037 You may need to set those up by hand.
12038 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
12039 something like:
12040
12041 @example
12042 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
12043 @end example
12044
12045 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
12046
12047 @example
12048 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
12049 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
12050 @end example
12051
12052 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
12053 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
12054 do not have such restrictions.
12055
12056 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
12057 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
12058 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
12059 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
12060
12061 @section Programming using GDB
12062 @cindex Programming using GDB
12063 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
12064
12065 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
12066 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
12067 @example
12068 gdb_memory_map disable
12069 @end example
12070 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
12071 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
12072 working area.
12073
12074 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
12075 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
12076 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
12077 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
12078
12079 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
12080 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
12081
12082 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
12083 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
12084 @example
12085 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
12086 @end example
12087
12088 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
12089 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
12090
12091 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
12092 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
12093 will be used.
12094
12095 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
12096 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
12097 @example
12098 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
12099 @end example
12100 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
12101
12102 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
12103 can be used.
12104
12105 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
12106 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
12107 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
12108
12109 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
12110 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
12111 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
12112
12113 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
12114 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
12115 and GDB treats it as it were running.
12116 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
12117 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
12118 without any intrusion of the target process.
12119
12120 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
12121 Place following command after target configuration:
12122 @example
12123 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
12124 @end example
12125
12126 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
12127 switch off gdb_memory_map:
12128 @example
12129 gdb_memory_map disable
12130 @end example
12131
12132 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
12133 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
12134 @example
12135 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
12136 @end example
12137
12138 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
12139 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
12140
12141 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
12142 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
12143 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
12144 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
12145
12146 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
12147 previously shown variables.
12148
12149 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
12150 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
12151 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
12152 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
12153 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
12154
12155 @section RTOS Support
12156 @cindex RTOS Support
12157 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
12158
12159 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
12160 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
12161
12162 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
12163 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
12164 GDB commands.
12165
12166 @* An example setup is below:
12167
12168 @example
12169 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
12170 @end example
12171
12172 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
12173
12174 Currently supported rtos's include:
12175 @itemize @bullet
12176 @item @option{eCos}
12177 @item @option{ThreadX}
12178 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
12179 @item @option{linux}
12180 @item @option{ChibiOS}
12181 @item @option{embKernel}
12182 @item @option{mqx}
12183 @item @option{uCOS-III}
12184 @item @option{nuttx}
12185 @item @option{RIOT}
12186 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
12187 @item @option{Zephyr}
12188 @item @option{rtkernel}
12189 @end itemize
12190
12191 At any time, it's possible to drop the selected RTOS using:
12192 @example
12193 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos none
12194 @end example
12195
12196 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
12197 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
12198
12199 @table @code
12200 @item eCos symbols
12201 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
12202 @item ThreadX symbols
12203 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
12204 @item FreeRTOS symbols
12205 @raggedright
12206 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
12207 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
12208 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority, xSchedulerRunning.
12209 @end raggedright
12210 @item linux symbols
12211 init_task.
12212 @item ChibiOS symbols
12213 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
12214 @item embKernel symbols
12215 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
12216 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
12217 @item mqx symbols
12218 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
12219 @item uC/OS-III symbols
12220 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
12221 @item nuttx symbols
12222 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
12223 @item RIOT symbols
12224 @raggedright
12225 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
12226 _tcb_name_offset.
12227 @end raggedright
12228 @item Zephyr symbols
12229 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
12230 @item rtkernel symbols
12231 Multiple struct offsets.
12232 @end table
12233
12234 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
12235 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
12236
12237 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
12238 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
12239
12240 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
12241 along with the project:
12242
12243 @table @code
12244 @item FreeRTOS
12245 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
12246 @item uC/OS-III
12247 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
12248 @end table
12249
12250 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
12251 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
12252 @cindex SMP
12253 @cindex RTOS
12254 @cindex hwthread
12255 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
12256 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
12257 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
12258 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
12259 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
12260 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
12261 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
12262 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
12263 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
12264
12265 @node Tcl Scripting API
12266 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
12267 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
12268 @cindex Tcl scripts
12269 @section API rules
12270
12271 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
12272 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
12273 of state information as an argument to each proc.
12274
12275 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
12276 pair list and lists.
12277
12278 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
12279 list.
12280
12281 @example
12282 > set foo(me) Duane
12283 > set foo(you) Oyvind
12284 > set foo(mouse) Micky
12285 > set foo(duck) Donald
12286 @end example
12287
12288 If one does this:
12289
12290 @example
12291 > set foo
12292 @end example
12293
12294 The result is:
12295
12296 @example
12297 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
12298 @end example
12299
12300 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
12301
12302 @verbatim
12303 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
12304 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
12305 }
12306 @end verbatim
12307
12308 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
12309 should be passed in to the proc in question.
12310
12311 @section Internal low-level Commands
12312
12313 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
12314 invoke directly.
12315
12316 @itemize
12317 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
12318
12319 Return information about the flash banks
12320
12321 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
12322
12323 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
12324 its execution. Example:
12325
12326 @example
12327 > capture "reset init"
12328 @end example
12329
12330 @end itemize
12331
12332 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
12333 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
12334 called "flash_banks".
12335
12336 @section Tcl RPC server
12337 @cindex RPC
12338
12339 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
12340 commands and receive the results.
12341
12342 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
12343 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
12344 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
12345 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
12346 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
12347
12348 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
12349 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
12350 @command{capture} command.
12351
12352 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
12353
12354 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
12355 @cindex RPC Notifications
12356
12357 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12358 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12359
12360 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
12361 in the following format.
12362
12363 @verbatim
12364 type target_event event [event-name]
12365 type target_state state [state-name]
12366 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
12367 @end verbatim
12368
12369 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
12370 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
12371 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12372 Defaults to off.
12373
12374 @end deffn
12375
12376 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
12377 @cindex RPC trace output
12378
12379 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
12380 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
12381
12382 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
12383
12384 @verbatim
12385 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
12386 @end verbatim
12387
12388 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
12389 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
12390 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
12391 Defaults to off.
12392
12393 See an example application here:
12394 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
12395
12396 @end deffn
12397
12398 @node FAQ
12399 @chapter FAQ
12400 @cindex faq
12401 @enumerate
12402 @anchor{faqrtck}
12403 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
12404 @cindex RTCK
12405 @cindex adaptive clocking
12406 @*
12407
12408 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
12409 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
12410 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
12411 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
12412
12413 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
12414 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
12415 for example. There are 2 basic options:
12416 @enumerate
12417 @item
12418 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
12419 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
12420 @item
12421 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
12422 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
12423 @end enumerate
12424
12425 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
12426 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
12427 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
12428 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
12429 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
12430 power).
12431
12432 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
12433 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
12434 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
12435 ARM926 scenario).
12436 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
12437 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
12438 JTAG can use a faster clock.
12439
12440 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
12441 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
12442 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
12443 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
12444
12445 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
12446
12447 In order to make use of this,
12448 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
12449 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
12450
12451 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
12452 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
12453 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
12454 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
12455 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
12456
12457 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
12458 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
12459 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
12460 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
12461
12462 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
12463 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
12464 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
12465 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
12466 with a CPLD.
12467 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
12468 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
12469 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
12470 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
12471 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
12472 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
12473
12474 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
12475
12476 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
12477
12478 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
12479 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
12480 depending on the chips on your board.
12481 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
12482 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
12483 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
12484
12485 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
12486 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
12487 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
12488
12489 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
12490 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
12491 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
12492 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
12493
12494 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
12495 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
12496 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
12497 this way.
12498
12499 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
12500 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
12501 clock rate.
12502 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
12503 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
12504 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
12505
12506 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
12507
12508 @example
12509 # Example: 1.234MHz
12510 adapter speed 1234
12511 @end example
12512
12513
12514 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
12515
12516 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
12517 around Windows filenames.
12518
12519 @example
12520 > echo \a
12521
12522 > echo @{\a@}
12523 \a
12524 > echo "\a"
12525
12526 >
12527 @end example
12528
12529
12530 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
12531
12532 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
12533 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
12534 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
12535
12536 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
12537 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
12538 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
12539
12540 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
12541 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
12542 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
12543
12544 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
12545
12546 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
12547 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
12548 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
12549 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
12550
12551 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
12552 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
12553 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
12554
12555 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
12556 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
12557
12558 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
12559 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
12560 memory read caused data abort".
12561
12562 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
12563 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
12564 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
12565 be done, feel free to add this here.
12566
12567 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
12568 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
12569 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
12570 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
12571 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
12572 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
12573 gracefully stops.
12574
12575 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
12576 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
12577 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
12578
12579 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
12580 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
12581 bytes. Painful...
12582
12583
12584 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
12585 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
12586
12587 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
12588 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
12589 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
12590 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
12591 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
12592 reset, everything else should work fine.
12593
12594 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
12595 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
12596 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
12597 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
12598
12599 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
12600 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
12601 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
12602 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
12603
12604 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
12605
12606 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
12607 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
12608 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
12609
12610 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
12611 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
12612
12613 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
12614 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
12615 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
12616 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
12617 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
12618 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
12619 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
12620 clock frequency?
12621
12622 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
12623 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
12624 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
12625 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
12626 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
12627
12628 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
12629
12630 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
12631 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
12632 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
12633 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
12634 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
12635 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
12636 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
12637
12638 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
12639
12640 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
12641 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
12642 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
12643 up DRAM and loading it with code.
12644
12645 @anchor{faqtaporder}
12646 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
12647 particular order?
12648
12649 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
12650 the same order used by the hardware.
12651
12652 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
12653 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
12654 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
12655 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
12656 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
12657 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
12658
12659 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
12660 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
12661 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
12662 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
12663
12664 @itemize @bullet
12665 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
12666 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
12667 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
12668 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
12669 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
12670 @end itemize
12671
12672 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
12673
12674 @itemize @bullet
12675 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
12676 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
12677 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
12678 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
12679 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
12680 @end itemize
12681
12682
12683 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
12684 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
12685 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
12686
12687 TODO.
12688
12689 @end enumerate
12690
12691 @node Tcl Crash Course
12692 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
12693 @cindex Tcl
12694
12695 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
12696 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
12697 how the Tcl scripts work.
12698
12699 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
12700 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
12701 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
12702 OpenOCD.
12703
12704 @section Tcl Rule #1
12705 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
12706 @enumerate
12707 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
12708 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12709 @end enumerate
12710
12711 The Tcl equal is this:
12712
12713 @enumerate
12714 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
12715 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12716 @end enumerate
12717
12718 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
12719 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
12720
12721 @section Tcl Rule #1b
12722 There is a second pair of rules.
12723 @enumerate
12724 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
12725 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
12726 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
12727 in Tcl.
12728 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
12729 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
12730 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
12731 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
12732 @end enumerate
12733
12734 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
12735 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
12736 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
12737 Everything is a string}
12738
12739 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
12740 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
12741 difference is subtle.
12742 @enumerate
12743 @item Parse Time
12744 @item Evaluation Time
12745 @end enumerate
12746
12747 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
12748 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
12749 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
12750
12751 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
12752 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
12753 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
12754 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
12755
12756 @itemize @bullet
12757 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
12758 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
12759 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
12760 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
12761 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
12762 @example
12763 # bash example
12764 X=`date`
12765 echo "The Date is: $X"
12766 # Tcl example
12767 set X [date]
12768 puts "The Date is: $X"
12769 @end example
12770 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
12771 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
12772 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
12773 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
12774 is a string}
12775 @example
12776 set x "Dinner"
12777 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
12778 @end example
12779 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
12780 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
12781 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
12782 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
12783 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
12784 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
12785 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
12786 @end itemize
12787
12788 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
12789
12790 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
12791
12792 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
12793
12794 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
12795 the normal way.
12796
12797 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
12798 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
12799 line is immediately executed.
12800
12801 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
12802 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
12803
12804 @subsection Command Execution
12805
12806 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
12807 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
12808 control flow operators.
12809
12810 Commands are executed like this:
12811
12812 @enumerate
12813 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
12814 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
12815 @item Repeat until End Of File.
12816 @end enumerate
12817
12818 It sort of works like this:
12819 @example
12820 for(;;)@{
12821 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
12822
12823 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
12824
12825 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
12826 @}
12827 @end example
12828
12829 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
12830 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
12831 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
12832 of the function. Note the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
12833 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
12834 ``LookupCommand()''
12835
12836 @subsection The FOR command
12837
12838 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
12839 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
12840 command just like any other command.
12841
12842 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
12843 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
12844 are:
12845
12846 @enumerate 0
12847 @item The ascii text 'for'
12848 @item The start text
12849 @item The test expression
12850 @item The next text
12851 @item The body text
12852 @end enumerate
12853
12854 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
12855 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
12856 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
12857 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
12858
12859 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
12860 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
12861
12862 @example
12863 int
12864 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
12865 int *argc,
12866 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
12867 @end example
12868
12869 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
12870 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
12871 still operates in the same basic way.
12872
12873 @subsection FOR command implementation
12874
12875 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
12876 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
12877
12878 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
12879
12880 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
12881
12882 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
12883 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
12884 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
12885
12886 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
12887 expression and returns a value.
12888
12889 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12890 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12891 @example
12892 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12893
12894 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12895
12896 int
12897 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12898 int argc,
12899 char **argv )
12900 @{
12901 if( argc != 5 )@{
12902 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
12903 return ERROR;
12904 @}
12905
12906 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
12907
12908 // Execute the start statement.
12909 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
12910
12911 // Top of loop test
12912 for(;;)@{
12913 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
12914 if( i == 0 )
12915 break;
12916
12917 // Execute the body
12918 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
12919
12920 // Execute the LOOP part
12921 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
12922 @}
12923
12924 // Return no error
12925 SetResult( interp, "" );
12926 return SUCCESS;
12927 @}
12928 @end example
12929
12930 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
12931 in the same basic way.
12932
12933 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
12934
12935 @subsection source and find commands
12936 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
12937 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
12938 @*Remember the parsing rules
12939 @enumerate
12940 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
12941 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
12942 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
12943 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
12944 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
12945 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
12946 That character begins Tcl comments.)
12947 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12948 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12949 @end enumerate
12950 @subsection format command
12951 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12952 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12953 @b{sprintf()}.
12954 @b{Example}
12955 @example
12956 set x 6
12957 set y 7
12958 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr @{$x * $y@}]]
12959 @end example
12960 @enumerate
12961 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12962 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12963 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12964 @* Refer to Rule #1
12965 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12966 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12967 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12968 @end enumerate
12969 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12970 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12971 @example
12972 #1 Good
12973 proc someproc @{@} @{
12974 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12975 @}
12976 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12977 #2 Good - no variables
12978 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12979 #3 Good Curly Braces
12980 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12981 puts "Time: [date]"
12982 @}
12983 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12984 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12985 @end example
12986 @enumerate
12987 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12988 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12989 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12990 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12991 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12992 command.
12993 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12994 @*There are 4 examples:
12995 @enumerate
12996 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12997 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12998 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12999 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
13000 @end enumerate
13001
13002 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
13003 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
13004 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
13005
13006 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
13007 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
13008 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
13009 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
13010 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
13011 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
13012 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
13013 @end enumerate
13014 @subsection Global Variables
13015 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
13016 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
13017 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
13018 @example
13019 proc myproc @{ @} @{
13020 set y 0 #Local variable Y
13021 global x #Global variable X
13022 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
13023 @}
13024 @end example
13025 @section Other Tcl Hacks
13026 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
13027 @example
13028 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
13029 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr @{$x + 1@}]@} @{
13030 # Create var name
13031 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
13032 # Make it a global
13033 global $vn
13034 # Set it.
13035 set $vn [expr @{1 << $x@}]
13036 @}
13037 @end example
13038 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
13039 @example
13040 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
13041 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
13042 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
13043 @}
13044 @end example
13045
13046 @node License
13047 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
13048 @include fdl.texi
13049
13050 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
13051 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
13052 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
13053 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
13054 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
13055 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
13056
13057 @printindex cp
13058
13059 @node Command and Driver Index
13060 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
13061 @printindex fn
13062
13063 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)